blob: 90a034643e7f4916c15db302be07ec76f12e8c84 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01005 version 1.5.10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubab84d42014-12-31 22:22:28 +01007 2014/12/31
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001326log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001327max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328maxconn X X X -
1329mode X X X X
1330monitor fail - X X -
1331monitor-net X X X -
1332monitor-uri X X X -
1333option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1334option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1335option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1336option allbackups (*) X - X X
1337option checkcache (*) X - X X
1338option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1339option contstats (*) X X X -
1340option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1341option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1342option forceclose (*) X X X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1344option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001345option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001346option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001347option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001348option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001349option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1351option httpchk X - X X
1352option httpclose (*) X X X X
1353option httplog X X X X
1354option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001355option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001356option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1358option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1359option logasap (*) X X X -
1360option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001361option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001362option nolinger (*) X X X X
1363option originalto X X X X
1364option persist (*) X - X X
1365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001367option smtpchk X - X X
1368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1370option splice-request (*) X X X X
1371option splice-response (*) X X X X
1372option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1373option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001375option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1377option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1378option tcpka X X X X
1379option tcplog X X X X
1380option transparent (*) X - X X
1381persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1382rate-limit sessions X X X -
1383redirect - X X X
1384redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1385redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1386reqadd - X X X
1387reqallow - X X X
1388reqdel - X X X
1389reqdeny - X X X
1390reqiallow - X X X
1391reqidel - X X X
1392reqideny - X X X
1393reqipass - X X X
1394reqirep - X X X
1395reqisetbe - X X X
1396reqitarpit - X X X
1397reqpass - X X X
1398reqrep - X X X
1399-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1400reqsetbe - X X X
1401reqtarpit - X X X
1402retries X - X X
1403rspadd - X X X
1404rspdel - X X X
1405rspdeny - X X X
1406rspidel - X X X
1407rspideny - X X X
1408rspirep - X X X
1409rsprep - X X X
1410server - - X X
1411source X - X X
1412srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001413stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414stats auth X - X X
1415stats enable X - X X
1416stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001417stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418stats realm X - X X
1419stats refresh X - X X
1420stats scope X - X X
1421stats show-desc X - X X
1422stats show-legends X - X X
1423stats show-node X - X X
1424stats uri X - X X
1425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1426stick match - - X X
1427stick on - - X X
1428stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001429stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001430stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001431tcp-check connect - - X X
1432tcp-check expect - - X X
1433tcp-check send - - X X
1434tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001435tcp-request connection - X X -
1436tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001437tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001438tcp-response content - - X X
1439tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440timeout check X - X X
1441timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001442timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1444timeout connect X - X X
1445timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1447timeout http-request X X X X
1448timeout queue X - X X
1449timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1452timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001453timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001455unique-id-format X X X -
1456unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001458use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1460 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1467
1468
1469acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1470 Declare or complete an access list.
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473 Example:
1474 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1475 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1476 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001481appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1482 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | no | yes | yes
1486 Arguments :
1487 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1488 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 checked in each cookie value.
1492
1493 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1494 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1495 milliseconds.
1496
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001497 request-learn
1498 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1499 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1500 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1501 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1502 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1503 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1504
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001505 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1506 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1507 data following this prefix.
1508
1509 Example :
1510 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1511
1512 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1513 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1514
1515 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1516 2 modes are currently supported :
1517 - path-parameters :
1518 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1519 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1520 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1521 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1522 - query-string :
1523 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1524 query string.
1525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1527 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1528 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1529 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001530 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1531 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1532 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1534 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1535
1536 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 Example :
1543 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001545 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1546 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547
1548
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001549backlog <conns>
1550 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1552 yes | yes | yes | no
1553 Arguments :
1554 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1555 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001556 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557
1558 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1559 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1560 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1561 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1562 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1563 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1564 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1565 backlog parameter.
1566
1567 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1568 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1569 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1570
1571 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1572
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001575balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | no | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1581 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1582 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1583 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1584
1585 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1586 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1587 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1588 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001589 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001590 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001591 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1592 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1593 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1594 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1595 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1596 it, so that you don't worry.
1597
1598 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1599 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1600 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1601 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1602 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1603 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1604 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1605 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001607 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1608 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1609 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1610 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1611 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1612 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1613 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1614 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1615
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001616 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001618 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1619 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001621 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1622 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1623 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1624 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1625 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001626 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1627 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1628 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1629 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1630 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1631 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1635 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1636 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1637 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1638 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1639 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1640 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1644 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1645 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001647 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1648 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1649 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1650 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1651 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1652 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1653 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1654 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1655 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1656 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1657 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1658 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001660 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001661 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1662 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1663 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1664 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1665 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1666 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1667 URIs start with a leading "/".
1668
1669 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1670 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1671 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1672 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1676
1677 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1679 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001680 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1681 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1682 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1683 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001685 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1686 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1689 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1690 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1691 server will receive the request.
1692
1693 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1694 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1695 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1696 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1697 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1699 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1700 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001702 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1703 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1704 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1705 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1706 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1710 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1711 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1712
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1716
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001717 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001718 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001719 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1720 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1721 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1722 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1723 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1724 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 used instead.
1727
1728 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1729 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1730 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1731 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1732
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001733 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1734 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1735 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001737 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1741 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001742
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001743 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1744 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1745 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746
1747 Examples :
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1752 balance hdr(host)
1753 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754
1755 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1756 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001758 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1760 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1761 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1762 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1763
1764 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1765 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1766 defaults to 16 kB.
1767
1768 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1769 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1770
1771 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1772 Round Robin.
1773
1774 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1775 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1776 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1777 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1778
1779 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1780
1781 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001782 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1784 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1785 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1788 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1792bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1795 no | yes | yes | no
1796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001797 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1798 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1799 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1800 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001801 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001802 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1803 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1804 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1805 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1806 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1807 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1808 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001809 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1810 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1811 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1812 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1813 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1814 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1815 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001816 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1817 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1818 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001819 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1820 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1821 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1822 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001823
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001824 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1825 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001826 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1827 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1828 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001829 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1830 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1831 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1832 the range.
1833
1834 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1835 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1836 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1837 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1838 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1839 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1840 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001841 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001842 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1845 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1846 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1847 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1848 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1849 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1850 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1851 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001853 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1854 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1855 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1856 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1859 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1860 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1861 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1862 in a frontend.
1863
1864 Example :
1865 listen http_proxy
1866 bind :80,:443
1867 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001868 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001870 listen http_https_proxy
1871 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001872 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001873
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001874 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1875 bind ipv6@:80
1876 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1877 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1878
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001879 listen external_bind_app1
1880 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001883 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
1885
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001886bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
1891 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1892 may be used to override a default value.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 option may be combined with other numbers.
1896
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1899 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1900 missing from all processes.
1901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001904 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1905 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1906 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1907 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001908
1909 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1910 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1911 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1912 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1913 and 'even' instances.
1914
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001915 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1916 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1917 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1918 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001920 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1921 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1922
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001923 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1924 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1925 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1926
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1928 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1929
1930 Example :
1931 listen app_ip1
1932 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001933 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
1935 listen app_ip2
1936 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001937 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939 listen management
1940 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001943 listen management
1944 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1945 bind-process 1-4
1946
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001947 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950block { if | unless } <condition>
1951 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 no | yes | yes | yes
1954
1955 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1956 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001957 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001958 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1960 "block" statements per instance.
1961
1962 Example:
1963 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1964 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1965 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1966 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
1970
1971capture cookie <name> len <length>
1972 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 no | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1977 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1978 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1979 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1980 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1981
1982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1983 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1984 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1985 right if it exceeds <length>.
1986
1987 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1988 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1989 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1990 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1991
1992 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1993 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1994 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1995
1996 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1997 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1998 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001999 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2000 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2001 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2005
2006 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
2009
2010capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002011 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002016 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2018 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2019 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2020
2021 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2022 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2023 it exceeds <length>.
2024
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2027 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002028 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2029 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2030 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2031 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 environments to find where the request came from.
2034
2035 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2036 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2037 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2038 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002040 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2041 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2042 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2043 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2044 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
2046 Example:
2047 capture request header Host len 15
2048 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2049 capture request header Referrer len 15
2050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 about logging.
2053
2054
2055capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002056 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 no | yes | yes | no
2059 Arguments :
2060 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002061 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2063 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2064 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2065
2066 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2067 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2068 it exceeds <length>.
2069
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2072 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2073 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002074 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2075 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2076 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2077 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002079 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2080 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2081 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2082 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2083 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 Example:
2086 capture response header Content-length len 9
2087 capture response header Location len 15
2088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 about logging.
2091
2092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002093clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | no
2097 Arguments :
2098 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2100 as explained at the top of this document.
2101
2102 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2104 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2105 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2106 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2107 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2108 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2109 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002110 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2112 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2113
2114 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2120
2121 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2122 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2125 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002127compression algo <algorithm> ...
2128compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002129compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002130 Enable HTTP compression.
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 yes | yes | yes | yes
2133 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2135 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2136 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2137
2138 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002139 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002140 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2141 data.
2142
2143 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2144 support for zlib was built in.
2145
2146 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2147 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2148 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2149 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2150 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2151 in.
2152
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002155 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2156 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2157 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2158 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2159 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002160
2161 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2162 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2164 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2165 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002166 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2167 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2168 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2169 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2170 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002171 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2172 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002173
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2176 "Accept-Encoding" header
2177 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002178 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002179 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2180 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2182 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2183 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2184 "multipart"
2185 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2186 header
2187 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2188 and later
2189 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2190 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002191
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002192 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2193 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002194
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002195 Examples :
2196 compression algo gzip
2197 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | no | yes | yes
2203 Arguments :
2204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2206 as explained at the top of this document.
2207
2208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2215
2216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2222
2223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2225 instead.
2226
2227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 yes | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2239 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2240 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2241 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2242 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2243 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2244 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2245 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2246 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2247
2248 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2249 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2250 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2251 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2252 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2253 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2254 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2255 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2256 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2257 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2258 "insert" and "prefix".
2259
2260 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002261 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2265 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2266 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2267 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2268 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2269 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2270 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2271 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2272 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2273 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2276 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2277 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2278 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2279 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2280 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2281 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2282 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2283 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2284 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2286 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2287 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002289 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2290 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2291 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002292 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2293 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2294 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2295 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002296 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2297 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2298 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2301 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2302 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2303 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2304 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2305 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2306 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2307 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2308 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2309
2310 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2311 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2312 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2313 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2314 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2315 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2316 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2317 persistence cookie in the cache.
2318 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2319
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002320 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2321 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2322 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2323 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2324 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2325 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2326 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2327 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2328 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2329 they logout.
2330
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002331 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2332 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2333 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2334 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2335
2336 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2337 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2338 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2339 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2340 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2341 this attribute.
2342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002343 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002345 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2346 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2347 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2348 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2349 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2350 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2353 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2354 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2355 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2356 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2357 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2358 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2359 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2360 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2361 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2362 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2363 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2364 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2365 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2366 the site.
2367
2368 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2369 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2370 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2371 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2372 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2373 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2374 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2375 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2376 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2377 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2378 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2379 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2381 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2382 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2383 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Examples :
2391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002396 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002397 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400default-server [param*]
2401 Change default options for a server in a backend
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2406 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2407 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2408 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002410 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002411 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2412
2413 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416default_backend <backend>
2417 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2419 yes | yes | yes | no
2420 Arguments :
2421 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2422
2423 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2424 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2425 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2426 will catch all undetermined requests.
2427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 Example :
2429
2430 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2431 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2432 default_backend dynamic
2433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002434 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002437description <string>
2438 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : string
2442
2443 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2444 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2445 it describes.
2446 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449disabled
2450 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | yes | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2456 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2457 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2458 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2459 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2460 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2461 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2462
2463 See also : "enabled"
2464
2465
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466dispatch <address>:<port>
2467 Set a default server address
2468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471
2472 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2473 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2474 during start-up.
2475
2476 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2477 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2478 possible with normal servers.
2479
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002480 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2482 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2483 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2484 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2485
2486 See also : "server"
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489enabled
2490 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 yes | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2496 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2497
2498 See also : "disabled"
2499
2500
2501errorfile <code> <file>
2502 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 yes | yes | yes | yes
2505 Arguments :
2506 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002507 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002510 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2513 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
2515 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2516 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2517 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2518
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002519 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2522 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2523 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2524 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2527 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2528 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2529 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2530 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2531 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2534 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2535 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002536 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2538
2539 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 Example :
2542 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2545 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548errorloc <code> <url>
2549errorloc302 <code> <url>
2550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
2553 Arguments :
2554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2558 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2559 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2560 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2561 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2562
2563 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2564 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2565 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2566
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002567 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002569 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2570 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2571 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2572 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2573 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2574 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2575 request.
2576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2578
2579
2580errorloc303 <code> <url>
2581 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2586 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2587
2588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2602 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2603 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002604 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605
2606 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002609force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2610 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2615 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2616 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2617 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2618 marked down for maintenance operations.
2619
2620 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2621 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2622 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2623 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2624 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2625 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2626 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2627 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2628 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2629
2630 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2631 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2632 is used.
2633
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002634 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002635 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002636
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638fullconn <conns>
2639 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2644 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2645
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002646 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002648 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2650 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2651 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2652 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2653 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002656 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2657 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002658 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2659 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2660 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 Example :
2663 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2664 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2665 # connections.
2666 backend dynamic
2667 fullconn 10000
2668 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2672
2673
2674grace <time>
2675 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Arguments :
2679 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2680 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2681 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2682
2683 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2684 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002685 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2687
2688 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2689 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2690 simplify it.
2691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002693hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2696 yes | no | yes | yes
2697 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2699 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2702 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2703 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2704 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2705 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2706 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2707 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2708 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2709 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2710 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2713 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2714 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2715 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2716 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2717 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2718 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2719 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2720 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2721 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2722 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2723 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2724 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2726 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002730 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2732 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2733 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2735 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2736 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002737
2738 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2739 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2741 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2742 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2743 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2744
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002745 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2746 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2747 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2748 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2749 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2750 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2751 parameter.
2752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002753 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2754
2755 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2756 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2757 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2758 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2759 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2760 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2761 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2762 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2763 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2764 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2765 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2766 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002767
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002768 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2769 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2770 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002771
2772 See also : "balance", "server"
2773
2774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775http-check disable-on-404
2776 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 Arguments : none
2780
2781 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2782 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2783 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2784 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2785 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2786 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2787 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2788 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2790 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2791 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2792
2793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2794
2795
2796http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 Arguments :
2801 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2802 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2805 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2806 details on the supported keywords.
2807
2808 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2809 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2810 with the usual backslash ('\').
2811
2812 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2813 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2814 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2815 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2816 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2817
2818 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2821 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823
2824 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2827 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2828 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2829 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2830
2831 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2837 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2838 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2839 trace).
2840
2841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002843 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2844 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2845 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2846 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2847 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2848 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2849
2850 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2851 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2852 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2853 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2854 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2855 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2856 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2857 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2858
2859 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2860 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2861
2862 Examples :
2863 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002864 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002865
2866 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002867 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002868
2869 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002870 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002871
2872 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002873 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002874
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002876
2877
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002878http-check send-state
2879 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2881 yes | no | yes | yes
2882 Arguments : none
2883
2884 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2885 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2886 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2887 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2888 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2889
2890 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2891 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2892 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2893 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2894 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2895 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2896 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2897 checked in multiple backends.
2898
2899 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2900 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2901
2902 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2903 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2904 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2905 one fails.
2906
2907 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2908 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2909 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2910
2911 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2912 server's queue.
2913
2914 Example of a header received by the application server :
2915 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2916 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2917
2918 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2919
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002920http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002921 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002922 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002923 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2924 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002925 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2926 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2927 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2928 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2929 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2930 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002932 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2933
2934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2935 no | yes | yes | yes
2936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002937 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2938 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2939 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2940 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2941 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002943 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2944 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2945 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2946
2947 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2948 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2949 are evaluated.
2950
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002951 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2952 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2953 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2954 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2955 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2956 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2957 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2958 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2959 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002960 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002961 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2962
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002963 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2964 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2965 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2966 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2967 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2968
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002969 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2970 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2971 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002972 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2973 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002974
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002975 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2976 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2977 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2978 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2979 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2980 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2981 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2982 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2983
2984 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2985 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2986 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2987 external users.
2988
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002989 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2990 <name>.
2991
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002992 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2993 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2994 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2995 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2996 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2997 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2998 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2999 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3000
3001 Example:
3002
3003 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3004
3005 applied to:
3006
3007 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3008
3009 outputs:
3010
3011 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3012
3013 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3014
3015 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3016 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3017 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3018 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3019 header.
3020
3021 Example:
3022
3023 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3024
3025 applied to:
3026
3027 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3028
3029 outputs:
3030
3031 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3032
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003033 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3034 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3035 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3036 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3037 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3038 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3039 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3040 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3041
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003042 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3043 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3044 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3045 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3046 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3047 another equipment.
3048
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003049 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3050 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3051 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3052 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3053 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3054 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3055 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3056 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3057
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003058 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3059 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3060 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3061 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3062 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3063 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3064 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3065 admin privileges.
3066
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003067 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3068 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3069 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3070 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3071 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3072 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3073 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3074 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3075
3076 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3077 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3078 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3079 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3080 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3081 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3082
3083 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3084 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3085 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3086 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3087 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3088 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3089
3090 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3091 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3092 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3093 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3094 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3095 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3096 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3097 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3098 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3099
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003100 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3101
3102 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3103 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3104 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3105 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003106
3107 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003108 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3109 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3110 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003111
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003112 http-request allow if nagios
3113 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3114 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3115 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003116
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003117 Example:
3118 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003119 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003120
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003121 Example:
3122 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3123 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3124 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3125 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3126 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3127 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3131
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003132 Example:
3133 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3134 acl add path /addacl
3135 acl del path /delacl
3136
3137 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3138
3139 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3140 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3141
3142 Example:
3143 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3144 acl setmap path /setmap
3145 acl delmap path /delmap
3146
3147 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3148
3149 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3150 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3151
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003152 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3153 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003154
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003155http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003156 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003157 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3158 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003159 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3160 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3161 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3162 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3163 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3164 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003166 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3167
3168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 no | yes | yes | yes
3170
3171 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3172 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3173 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3174 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3175 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3176 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3177
3178 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3179 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3180 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3181 current section.
3182
3183 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3184 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3185 rules are evaluated.
3186
3187 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3188 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3189 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3190 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3191 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3192 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3193 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3194
3195 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3196 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3197 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3198 external users.
3199
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003200 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3201 <name>.
3202
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003203 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3204 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3205 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3206 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3207 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3208 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3209 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3210 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3211
3212 Example:
3213
3214 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3215
3216 applied to:
3217
3218 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3219
3220 outputs:
3221
3222 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3223
3224 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3225
3226 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3227 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3228 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3229 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3230 header.
3231
3232 Example:
3233
3234 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3235
3236 applied to:
3237
3238 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3239
3240 outputs:
3241
3242 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3243
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003244 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3245 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3246 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3247 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3248 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3249 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3250 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3251 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3252
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003253 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3254 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3255 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3256 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3257 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3258 another equipment.
3259
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003260 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3261 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3262 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3263 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3264 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3265 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3266 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3267 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3268
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003269 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3270 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3271 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3272 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3273 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3274 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3275 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3276 admin privileges.
3277
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003278 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3279 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3280 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3281 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3282 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3283 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3284 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3285 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3286
3287 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3288 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3289 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3290 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3291 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3292 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3293
3294 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3295 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3296 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3297 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3298 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3299 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3300
3301 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3302 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3303 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3304 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3305 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3306 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3307 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3308 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3309 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3310
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003311 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3312
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003313 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003314 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3315 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3316 rules.
3317
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003318 Example:
3319 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3320
3321 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3322
3323 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3324 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3325
3326 Example:
3327 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3328
3329 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3330
3331 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3332 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3333
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003334 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3335 ACL usage.
3336
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003337
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003338http-send-name-header [<header>]
3339 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3340
3341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3342 yes | no | yes | yes
3343
3344 Arguments :
3345
3346 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3347
3348 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3349 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3350 is added with the header string proved.
3351
3352 See also : "server"
3353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003354id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003355 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 no | yes | yes | yes
3358 Arguments : none
3359
3360 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3361 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3362 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003363
3364
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003365ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3366 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 no | yes | yes | yes
3369
3370 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3371 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3372 and running).
3373
3374 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3375 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3376 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003377 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003378 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3379
3380 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3381 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3382
3383 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3384 "unless" condition is met.
3385
3386 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3387
3388
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003389log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003390log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003391no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3394 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003395
3396 Prefix :
3397 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3398 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3399 prefix does not allow arguments.
3400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003401 Arguments :
3402 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3403 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3404 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3405 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3406 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3407 parameter.
3408
3409 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3410 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3411
3412 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3413 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3414 standard syslog port).
3415
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003416 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3417 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3418 standard syslog port).
3419
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003420 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3421 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3422 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3423 appropriately writeable).
3424
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003425 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3426 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3427 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3428 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3429
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003430 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3431 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3432 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3433 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3434 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3435 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3436 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3437 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3438 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3439 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3440 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003442 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3443
3444 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3445 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3446 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3447
3448 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3449 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3450 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003451 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3452 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3453 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3454 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3455 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003456
3457 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3458
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003459 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3460 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3461 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003462
3463 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3464 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3465 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3466 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3467
3468 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3469 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470
3471 Example :
3472 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003473 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3474 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003475 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3476
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003477
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003478log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003479 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003482
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003483 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3484 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3485 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3486 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3487 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003489
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003490max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3491 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | no | yes | yes
3494
3495 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3496 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3497 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3498 servers.
3499
3500 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3501 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3502 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3503 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3504 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3505 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3506 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3507 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3508 picking a different server.
3509
3510 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3511 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3512 even if they have to be queued.
3513
3514 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3515 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3516
3517
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003518maxconn <conns>
3519 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | yes | yes | no
3522 Arguments :
3523 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3524 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3525 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3526 closes.
3527
3528 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3529 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3530 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3531 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3532 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3533 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3534 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3535 properly tuned.
3536
3537 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3538 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3539 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3540
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003541 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003543 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3544
3545
3546mode { tcp|http|health }
3547 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3549 yes | yes | yes | yes
3550 Arguments :
3551 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3552 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3553 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3554 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3555
3556 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3557 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3558 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3559 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3560 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3561
3562 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003563 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3564 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3565 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3566 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3567 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3568 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3569 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003570
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003571 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3572 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3573 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003574
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003575 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003576 defaults http_instances
3577 mode http
3578
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003579 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003581
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003582monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586 Arguments :
3587 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3588 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003589 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3591 backend and its backup.
3592
3593 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3594 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3595 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3596 servers in a list of backends.
3597
3598 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3599 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3600 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3601 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3602 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3603 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3604 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003605 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3606 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003607
3608 Example:
3609 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003610 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3612 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3613 monitor-uri /site_alive
3614 monitor fail if site_dead
3615
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003616 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003617
3618
3619monitor-net <source>
3620 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3622 yes | yes | yes | no
3623 Arguments :
3624 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3625 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3626 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3627 followed by a mask.
3628
3629 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3630 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003631 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003632 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3633
3634 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3635 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3636 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3637 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003638 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3639 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3640 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003642 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3643 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3644 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3645 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3646 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3647 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003649 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3650 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003651
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003652 Example :
3653 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3654 frontend www
3655 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3656
3657 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3658
3659
3660monitor-uri <uri>
3661 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | yes | yes | no
3664 Arguments :
3665 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3666 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3667
3668 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3669 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3670 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3671 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3672 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3673 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3674 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3675 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3676
3677 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3678 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3679 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3680 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3681 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3682 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3683
3684 Example :
3685 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3686 frontend www
3687 mode http
3688 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3689
3690 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003693option abortonclose
3694no option abortonclose
3695 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | no | yes | yes
3698 Arguments : none
3699
3700 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3701 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3702 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3703 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003704 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003705 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3706 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3707 encountered while delivering the response.
3708
3709 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3710 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3711 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3712 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3713 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3714 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003715 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003716 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003717 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003718 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3719 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3720 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3721
3722 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3723 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3724 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3725 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3726 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3727 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3728 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3729 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003730 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003731
3732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3734
3735 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3736
3737
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003738option accept-invalid-http-request
3739no option accept-invalid-http-request
3740 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | no
3743 Arguments : none
3744
3745 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3746 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3747 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3748 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3749 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3750 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3751 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3752 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003753 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3754 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3755 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3756 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3757 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3758 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003759
3760 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3761 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3762 been confirmed.
3763
3764 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3765 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003766 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3767 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003768 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3769
3770 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3771 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3772
3773 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3774 stats socket.
3775
3776
3777option accept-invalid-http-response
3778no option accept-invalid-http-response
3779 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | no | yes | yes
3782 Arguments : none
3783
3784 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3785 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3786 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3787 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3788 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3789 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3790 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3791 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3792 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3793
3794 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3795 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3796 been confirmed.
3797
3798 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3799 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3800 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3801 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3802
3803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3805
3806 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3807 stats socket.
3808
3809
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003810option allbackups
3811no option allbackups
3812 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 yes | no | yes | yes
3815 Arguments : none
3816
3817 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3818 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3819 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3820 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3821 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3822 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3823 order between the backup servers anymore.
3824
3825 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3826 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3827
3828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3830
3831
3832option checkcache
3833no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003834 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 yes | no | yes | yes
3837 Arguments : none
3838
3839 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3840 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003841 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003842 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3843 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003844 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003845
3846 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003847 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003848 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003849 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3850 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003851 to the client are :
3852 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003853 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003854 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003855 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3856 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3857 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3858 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3859 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3860 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3861 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3862 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3863 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3865 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3866
3867 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003868 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003869 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003870 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003871 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3872
3873 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3874 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003875 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003876 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3877
3878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3880
3881
3882option clitcpka
3883no option clitcpka
3884 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | yes | yes | no
3887 Arguments : none
3888
3889 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3890 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3891 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3892 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3893
3894 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3895 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3896 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3897 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3898
3899 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3900 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3901 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3902 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3903 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3904
3905 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3906
3907 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3908 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3909 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3910
3911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3913
3914 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3915
3916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917option contstats
3918 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | yes | yes | no
3921 Arguments : none
3922
3923 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3924 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3925 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3926 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3927 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3928 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3929 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3930
3931
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003932option dontlog-normal
3933no option dontlog-normal
3934 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | yes | yes | no
3937 Arguments : none
3938
3939 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3940 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3941 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3942 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3943 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3944 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3945 logged.
3946
3947 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3948 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3949 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003951 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003952 logging.
3953
3954
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003955option dontlognull
3956no option dontlognull
3957 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments : none
3961
3962 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3963 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3964 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3965 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3966 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3967 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3968 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3969
3970 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3971 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3972 would not be logged.
3973
3974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003977 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003978
3979
3980option forceclose
3981no option forceclose
3982 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003984 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003985 Arguments : none
3986
3987 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3988 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3989 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3990 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3991 global session times in the logs.
3992
3993 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003994 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003995 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003996
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003997 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3998 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3999 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4000
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004001 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4002 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004003
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4006
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004007 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004008
4009
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004010option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004011 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | yes
4014 Arguments :
4015 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4016 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004017 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004018 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004019
4020 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4021 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4022 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4023 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4024 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4025 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4026 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004027 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4028 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4029 possible that the client has already brought one.
4030
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004031 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004032 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004033 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4034 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004035 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4036 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004037
4038 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4039 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4040 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4041 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4042 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4043 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4044 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4045
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004046 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4047 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4048 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4049 are under the control of the end-user.
4050
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004051 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004052 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4053 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004054 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4055 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4056 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004057
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004058 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004059 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4060 frontend www
4061 mode http
4062 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4063
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004064 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4065 backend www
4066 mode http
4067 option forwardfor header X-Client
4068
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004069 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004070 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004071
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004072
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004073option http-keep-alive
4074no option http-keep-alive
4075 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | yes | yes | yes
4078 Arguments : none
4079
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004080 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4081 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4082 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4083 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4084 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4085 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4086 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4087
4088 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4089 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004090 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4091 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4092 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4093 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4094 situations where this option may be useful :
4095
4096 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4097 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4098
4099 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4100 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4101
4102 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4103 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4104 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4105 request.
4106
4107 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4108 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004109 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4110 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4111 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004112
4113 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4114 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4115
4116 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4117 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4118 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4119 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4120 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4121 not set.
4122
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004123 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4124 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004125 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004126 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004127
4128 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004129 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4130 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004131
4132
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004133option http-no-delay
4134no option http-no-delay
4135 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4137 yes | yes | yes | yes
4138 Arguments : none
4139
4140 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4141 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4142 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4143 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4144 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4145 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4146 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4147 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4148 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4149 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4150 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4151 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4152 affected.
4153
4154 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4155 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4156 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4157 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4158 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4159 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4160 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4161 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4162 latency environments.
4163
4164
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004165option http-pretend-keepalive
4166no option http-pretend-keepalive
4167 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | yes | yes | yes
4170 Arguments : none
4171
4172 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4173 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4174 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4175 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4176 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4177 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4178 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4179 consider the response complete.
4180
4181 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4182 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4183 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4184 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4185 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4186 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4187
4188 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4189 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4190 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4191 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4192 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4193 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4194 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4195
4196 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4197 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004198 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004199 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4200 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004201
4202 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4203 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4204
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004205 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4206 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004207
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004208
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004209option http-server-close
4210no option http-server-close
4211 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 yes | yes | yes | yes
4214 Arguments : none
4215
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004216 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4217 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4218 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4219 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4220 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4221 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4222 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4223 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4224 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4225 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4226 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4227 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4228 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4229 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4230 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4231 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004232
4233 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4234 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4235 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4236 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004237 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4238 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004239
4240 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4241 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004242 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4243 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004244 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4245 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004246
4247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4249
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004250 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004251 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4252 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004253
4254
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004255option http-tunnel
4256no option http-tunnel
4257 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4259 yes | yes | yes | yes
4260 Arguments : none
4261
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004262 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4263 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4264 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4265 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4266 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4267 "option http-tunnel".
4268
4269 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004270 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004271 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4272 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4273 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4274 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4275 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4276 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4277 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004278
4279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4281
4282 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4283 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4284 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4285
4286
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004287option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004288no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004289 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | yes | yes | no
4292 Arguments : none
4293
4294 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4295 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4296 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4297 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4298 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4299 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4300 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4301
4302 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4303 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4304 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4305 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4306 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4307 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4308 request along its whole life.
4309
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004310 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4311 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4312 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4313 front of an existing proxy.
4314
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004315 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4316
4317 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4318 http-server-close".
4319
4320
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004321option httpchk
4322option httpchk <uri>
4323option httpchk <method> <uri>
4324option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4325 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | no | yes | yes
4328 Arguments :
4329 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4330 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4331 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4332 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4333 ones.
4334
4335 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4336 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4337 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4338
4339 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4340 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4341 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4342 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4343 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4344
4345 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4346 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4347 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4348 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4349 the lack of any response.
4350
4351 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4352
4353 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4354 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4355 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4356
4357 Examples :
4358 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4359 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4360 backend https_relay
4361 mode tcp
4362 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4363 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4364
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004365 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4366 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4367 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004368
4369
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004370option httpclose
4371no option httpclose
4372 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4374 yes | yes | yes | yes
4375 Arguments : none
4376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004377 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4378 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4379 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4380 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004381 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004382 "option http-tunnel".
4383
4384 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4385 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4386 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4387 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4388 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4389 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4390 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4391 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004392
4393 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004394 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004395 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4396 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4397 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4398 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4399 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004400
4401 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4402 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004403 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4404 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004405 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4406 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004407
4408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4410
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004411 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4412 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004413
4414
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004415option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004416 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004419 Arguments :
4420 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4421 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4422 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4423 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4424 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004425
4426 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4427 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4428 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4429 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4430 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4431 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4432 ports.
4433
4434 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4435
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004436 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4437 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004439 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004441
4442option http_proxy
4443no option http_proxy
4444 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 yes | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments : none
4448
4449 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4450 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4451 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4452 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4453 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4454
4455 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4456 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4457 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4458 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004459 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004460 be analyzed.
4461
4462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4464
4465 Example :
4466 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4467 backend direct_forward
4468 option httpclose
4469 option http_proxy
4470
4471 See also : "option httpclose"
4472
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004473
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004474option independent-streams
4475no option independent-streams
4476 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | yes | yes | yes
4479 Arguments : none
4480
4481 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4482 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4483 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4484 receive data or not.
4485
4486 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4487 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4488 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4489 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4490 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4491 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4492 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4493 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4494 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4495 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4496 socket buffers.
4497
4498 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4499 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4500 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4501 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4502 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004504 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004505 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4506 deprecated.
4507
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004508 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004509
4510
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004511option ldap-check
4512 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4514 yes | no | yes | yes
4515 Arguments : none
4516
4517 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4518 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4519 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4520 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4521
4522 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4523 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4524
4525 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4526 configure it.
4527
4528 Example :
4529 option ldap-check
4530
4531 See also : "option httpchk"
4532
4533
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004534option log-health-checks
4535no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004536 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4538 yes | no | yes | yes
4539 Arguments : none
4540
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004541 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4542 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4543 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004544
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004545 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4546 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4547 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4548 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4549 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4550
4551 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4552 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004553
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004554 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4555 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4556 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004557
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004558
4559option log-separate-errors
4560no option log-separate-errors
4561 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 yes | yes | yes | no
4564 Arguments : none
4565
4566 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4567 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4568 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4569 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4570 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4571 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4572 provides very important information.
4573
4574 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4575 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4576 error logs.
4577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004578 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004579 logging.
4580
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004581
4582option logasap
4583no option logasap
4584 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | yes | yes | no
4587 Arguments : none
4588
4589 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4590 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4591 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4592 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4593 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4594 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4595 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004596 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004597 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4598 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004600 Examples :
4601 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4602 mode http
4603 option httplog
4604 option logasap
4605 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4606
4607 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4608 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4609 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4610 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004612 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004613 logging.
4614
4615
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004616option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004617 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004620 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004621 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4622 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004623 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004624
4625 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4626 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4627 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4628 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4629 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4630 in the MySQL table, like this :
4631
4632 USE mysql;
4633 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4634 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4635
4636 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4637 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4638 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4639 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4640 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4641 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4642 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4643 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4644 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4645
4646 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4647 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004648
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004649 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004650
4651 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4652 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4653 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4654 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4655 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4656 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4657
4658 See also: "option httpchk"
4659
4660
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004661option nolinger
4662no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004663 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004666 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004667
4668 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4669 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4670 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4671 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4672 connections.
4673
4674 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4675 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4676 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4677 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4678 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4679 this too.
4680
4681 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4682 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4683 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4684
4685 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4686 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4687 for servers.
4688
4689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4691
4692
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004693option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4694 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
4698 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4699 matching <network>
4700 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4701 header name.
4702
4703 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4704 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4705 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4706 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4707 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4708 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4709 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4710 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4711 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4712 possible that the client has already brought one.
4713
4714 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4715 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4716 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4717 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4718 header and requires different one.
4719
4720 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4721 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4722 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4723 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4724 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4725 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4726 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4727
4728 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4729 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4730 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4731 both are defined.
4732
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004733 Examples :
4734 # Original Destination address
4735 frontend www
4736 mode http
4737 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4738
4739 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4740 backend www
4741 mode http
4742 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4743
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004744 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4745 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004746
4747
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004748option persist
4749no option persist
4750 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004753 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004754
4755 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4756 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4757 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4758 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4759 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4760 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4761 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4762 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4763 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4764 redirected to another valid server.
4765
4766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4768
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004769 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004770
4771
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004772option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4773 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | no | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4778 PostgreSQL server.
4779
4780 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4781 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4782 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4783 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4784
4785 See also: "option httpchk"
4786
4787
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004788option prefer-last-server
4789no option prefer-last-server
4790 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | no | yes | yes
4793 Arguments : none
4794
4795 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4796 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4797 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4798 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4799 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4800 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4801 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4802 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4803 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004804 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4805 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4806 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4807 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4808 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4809 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4810 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004811
4812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4814
4815 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4816
4817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004818option redispatch
4819no option redispatch
4820 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004823 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004824
4825 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4826 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4827 be able to access the service anymore.
4828
4829 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4830 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4831
4832 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4833 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4834 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004836 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4837 "redisp" keywords.
4838
4839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4841
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004842 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004843
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004844
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004845option redis-check
4846 Use redis health checks for server testing
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | no | yes | yes
4849 Arguments : none
4850
4851 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4852 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4853 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4854 find the "+PONG" response message.
4855
4856 Example :
4857 option redis-check
4858
4859 See also : "option httpchk"
4860
4861
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004862option smtpchk
4863option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4864 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004868 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4869 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4870 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4871
4872 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4873 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4874 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4875
4876 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4877 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4878 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4879 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4880 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4881 dead server.
4882
4883 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4884 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4885 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4886 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4887
4888 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4889 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4890 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4891 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4892 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4893
4894 Example :
4895 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4896
4897 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004900option socket-stats
4901no option socket-stats
4902
4903 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | no
4906
4907 Arguments : none
4908
4909
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004910option splice-auto
4911no option splice-auto
4912 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments : none
4916
4917 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4918 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4919 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4920 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004922 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4923 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4924 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4925 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4926
4927 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4928 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4929 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4930 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4931 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4932 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4933 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4934 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4935 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4936 keyword.
4937
4938 Example :
4939 option splice-auto
4940
4941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4943
4944 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4945 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4946
4947
4948option splice-request
4949no option splice-request
4950 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | yes
4953 Arguments : none
4954
4955 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004956 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004957 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4958 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4959 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4960 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4961
4962 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4963
4964 Example :
4965 option splice-request
4966
4967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4969
4970 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4971 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4972
4973
4974option splice-response
4975no option splice-response
4976 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979 Arguments : none
4980
4981 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004982 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004983 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4984 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4985 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4986 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4987
4988 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4989
4990 Example :
4991 option splice-response
4992
4993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4995
4996 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4997 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4998
4999
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005000option srvtcpka
5001no option srvtcpka
5002 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | no | yes | yes
5005 Arguments : none
5006
5007 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5008 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5009 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5010 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5011
5012 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5013 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5014 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5015 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5016
5017 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5018 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5019 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5020 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5021 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5022
5023 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5024
5025 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5026 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5027 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5028
5029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5031
5032 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5033
5034
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005035option ssl-hello-chk
5036 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | no | yes | yes
5039 Arguments : none
5040
5041 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5042 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5043 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5044 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5045 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5046 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5047 hello message.
5048
5049 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5050 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5051 messages, which is appreciable.
5052
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005053 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5054 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5055 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005056
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005057 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5058
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005059
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005060option tcp-check
5061 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | no | yes | yes
5064
5065 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5066 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5067
5068 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5069 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5070 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5071
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005072 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005073 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5074 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5075 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5076 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5077 only.
5078
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005079 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005080 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5081 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5082 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5083 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5084
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005085 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005086 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5087 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005088 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005089 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5090 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5091 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5092 the respective protocols.
5093 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5094 analysed.
5095
5096 Examples :
5097 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5098 option tcp-check
5099 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5100
5101 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5102 option tcp-check
5103 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5104
5105 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5106 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005107 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005108 option tcp-check
5109 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5110 tcp-check expect +PONG
5111 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5112 tcp-check expect string role:master
5113 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5114 tcp-check expect string +OK
5115
5116 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5117 (send many headers before analyzing)
5118 option tcp-check
5119 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5120 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5121 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5122 tcp-check send \r\n
5123 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5124
5125
5126 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5127
5128
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005129option tcp-smart-accept
5130no option tcp-smart-accept
5131 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | yes | yes | no
5134 Arguments : none
5135
5136 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5137 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5138 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5139 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5140 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5141 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5142
5143 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5144 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5145 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5146 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5147
5148 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5149 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5150 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5151 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5152
5153 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5154 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5155 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5156
5157 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5158 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5159 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5160
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005161 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5162
5163
5164option tcp-smart-connect
5165no option tcp-smart-connect
5166 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | no | yes | yes
5169 Arguments : none
5170
5171 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5172 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5173 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5174 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5175 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5176
5177 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5178 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5179 complex.
5180
5181 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5182 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5183 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5184
5185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5187
5188 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5189
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005190
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005191option tcpka
5192 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | yes | yes | yes
5195 Arguments : none
5196
5197 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5198 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5199 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5200 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5201
5202 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5203 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5204 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5205 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5206
5207 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5208 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5209 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5210 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5211 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5212
5213 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5214
5215 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5216 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5217 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5218 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5219 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5220 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5221 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5222 backends.
5223
5224 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5225
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005226
5227option tcplog
5228 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5230 yes | yes | yes | yes
5231 Arguments : none
5232
5233 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5234 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5235 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5236 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5237 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5238 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5239 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5240 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5241
5242 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005244 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005245
5246
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005247option transparent
5248no option transparent
5249 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005251 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5255 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5256 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5257 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5258 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5259 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5260 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5261 appropriate server.
5262
5263 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5264 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5265
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005266 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005267 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005268
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005269
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005270persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005271persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005272 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | no | yes | yes
5275 Arguments :
5276 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005277 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5278 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005279
5280 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5281 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5282 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5283 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5284 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5285 forwarded to this server.
5286
5287 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5288 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5289 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005290 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005291 a single "listen" section.
5292
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005293 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5294 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5295 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5296
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005297 Example :
5298 listen tse-farm
5299 bind :3389
5300 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5301 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5302 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5303 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5304 persist rdp-cookie
5305 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005306 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005307 balance rdp-cookie
5308 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5309 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5310
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005311 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5312 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005313
5314
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005315rate-limit sessions <rate>
5316 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | yes | yes | no
5319 Arguments :
5320 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5321 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5322
5323 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5324 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5325 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5326 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5327 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5328 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5329
5330 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5331 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5332 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5333 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5334
5335 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5336 listen smtp
5337 mode tcp
5338 bind :25
5339 rate-limit sessions 10
5340 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5341
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005342 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5343 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5344 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005345
5346 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5347
5348
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005349redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5350redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5351redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005352 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5354 no | yes | yes | yes
5355
5356 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005357 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005358
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005359 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005360 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005361 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5362 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5363 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005364
5365 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5366 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5367 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5368 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5369 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005370 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5371 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5372 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5373 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005374
5375 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5376 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5377 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5378 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5379 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5380 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005381 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005382 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005383 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5384 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5385 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005386
5387 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005388 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5389 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5390 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5391 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5392 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5393 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5394 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5395 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005396
5397 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5398 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5399
5400 - "drop-query"
5401 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5402 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5403 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5404 with a location-type redirect.
5405
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005406 - "append-slash"
5407 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5408 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5409 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5410 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5411
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005412 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5413 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5414 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5415 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5416 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5417 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5418 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5419
5420 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5421 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5422 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5423 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5424 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5425 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5426 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005427
5428 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5429 acl clear dst_port 80
5430 acl secure dst_port 8080
5431 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005432 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005433 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005434 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5435
5436 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005437 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5438 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5439 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005440 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005441
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005442 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5443 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5444 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5445
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005446 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005447 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005448
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005449 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5450 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5451 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005453 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005454
5455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005456redisp (deprecated)
5457redispatch (deprecated)
5458 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005461 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005462
5463 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5464 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5465 be able to access the service anymore.
5466
5467 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5468 redistribute them to a working server.
5469
5470 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5471 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5472 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005474 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5475 "option redispatch" instead.
5476
5477 See also : "option redispatch"
5478
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005479
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005480reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005481 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5483 no | yes | yes | yes
5484 Arguments :
5485 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5486 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005487 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005488
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005492 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5493 the last header of an HTTP request.
5494
5495 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5496 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5497 responses.
5498
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005499 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5500 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5501 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5502
5503 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5504 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005505
5506
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005507reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5508reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005509 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 no | yes | yes | yes
5512 Arguments :
5513 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5514 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5515 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5516 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5517 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5518 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5519 ignores case.
5520
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005521 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5522 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5523
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005524 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5525 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5526 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5527 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005528 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529
5530 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5531 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5532
5533 Example :
5534 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5535 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5536 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005538 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5539 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005540
5541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005542reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5543reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005544 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5546 no | yes | yes | yes
5547 Arguments :
5548 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5549 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5550 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5551 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5552 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5553 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005555 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5556 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5557
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005558 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5559 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5560 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5561 next servers.
5562
5563 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5564 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5565 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5566
5567 Example :
5568 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5569 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5570 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005572 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5573 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005574
5575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005576reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5577reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005578 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5580 no | yes | yes | yes
5581 Arguments :
5582 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5583 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5584 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5585 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5586 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5587 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5588 case.
5589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005590 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5591 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5592
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005593 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5594 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5595 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5596 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005597 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005599 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005600 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005601 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005602
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5604 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5605
5606 Example :
5607 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5608 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5609 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5610
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005611 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5612 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613
5614
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005615reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5616reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005617 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 no | yes | yes | yes
5620 Arguments :
5621 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5622 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5623 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5624 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5625 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5626 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5627 case.
5628
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5633 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5634 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5635 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5636
5637 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5638 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5639
5640 Example :
5641 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5642 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5643 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5644 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5645
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005646 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5647 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005648
5649
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005650reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5651reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005652 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5654 no | yes | yes | yes
5655 Arguments :
5656 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5657 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5658 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5659 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5660 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5661 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5662
5663 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5664 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5665 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5666 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005667 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005669 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5670 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5671
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005672 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5673 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5674 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5675
5676 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5677 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5678 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5679 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5680 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5681
5682 Example :
5683 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005684 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5686 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5687
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005688 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5689 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005690
5691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005692reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5693reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005694 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 no | yes | yes | yes
5697 Arguments :
5698 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5699 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5700 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5701 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5702 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5703 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5704 ignores case.
5705
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005706 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5707 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5708
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5710 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005711 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5712 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5713 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005714 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5715 not set.
5716
5717 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5718 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5719 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5720 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5721 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5722
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005723 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005724 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5725 # block all others.
5726 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5727 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5728
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005729 # block bad guys
5730 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5731 reqitarpit . if badguys
5732
5733 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5734 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005735
5736
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005737retries <value>
5738 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 yes | no | yes | yes
5741 Arguments :
5742 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5743 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5744 default value is 3.
5745
5746 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5747 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5748 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5749
5750 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5751 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5752
5753 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5754 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5755
5756 See also : "option redispatch"
5757
5758
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005759rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 no | yes | yes | yes
5763 Arguments :
5764 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5765 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005766 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005767
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005768 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5769 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5770
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005771 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5772 the last header of an HTTP response.
5773
5774 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5775 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5776 responses.
5777
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005778 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5779 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005780
5781
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005782rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5783rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005784 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 no | yes | yes | yes
5787 Arguments :
5788 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5789 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5790 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5791 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5792 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5793 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5794 ignores case.
5795
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005796 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5797 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5798
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005799 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5800 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005801 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005802 client.
5803
5804 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5805 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5806 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5807
5808 Example :
5809 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005810 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005811
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005812 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5813 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005814
5815
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005816rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5817rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005818 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 no | yes | yes | yes
5821 Arguments :
5822 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5823 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5824 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5825 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5826 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5827 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5828 ignores case.
5829
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005830 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5831 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5832
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005833 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5834 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5835 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5836 case-sensitive.
5837
5838 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005839 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5840 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5841 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005842
5843 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5844 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5845
5846 Example :
5847 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5848 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5849
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005850 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5851 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005852
5853
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005854rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5855rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005856 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 no | yes | yes | yes
5859 Arguments :
5860 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5861 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5862 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5863 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5864 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5865 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5866 ignores case.
5867
5868 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5869 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5870 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5871 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005872 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005873
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005874 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5875 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5876
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005877 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5878 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5879 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5880
5881 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5882 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5883 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5884 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5885 are not case-sensitive.
5886
5887 Example :
5888 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5889 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005891 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5892 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005893
5894
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005895server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005896 Declare a server in a backend
5897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5898 no | no | yes | yes
5899 Arguments :
5900 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005901 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005902 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005903
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005904 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5905 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5906 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5907 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005908 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5909 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5910 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5911 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5912 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005913 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5914 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5915 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5916 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5917 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5918 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5919 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005920 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005921 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5922 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5923 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5924 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005926 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005927 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5928 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5929 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5930 adding this value to the client's port.
5931
5932 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5933 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005934 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005935
5936 Examples :
5937 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5938 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005939 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005940 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5941 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5942 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005943
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005944 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5945 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005946
5947
5948source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005949source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005950source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | no | yes | yes
5954 Arguments :
5955 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5956 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005957
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005958 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005959 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5960 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5961 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5962 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5963 supported prefixes are :
5964 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5965 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5966 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005967 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005968 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5969 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5970 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5971 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005972
5973 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5974 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005975 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5976 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5977 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005978
5979 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5980 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5981 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5982 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5983 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5984 <addr>.
5985
5986 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5987 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5988 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5989 port.
5990
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005991 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5992 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5993 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5994 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005995 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005996 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5997 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5998 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5999 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6000 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6001 HTTP header.
6002
6003 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6004 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006005 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006006 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6007 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6008 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6009 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6010 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6011 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6012 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6013
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006014 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6015 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6016 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6017 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6018 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6019 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6020
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006021 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6022 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6023 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6024 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6025
6026 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6027 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6028 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6029 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6030 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6031 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6032
6033 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6034 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6035 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6036 there are two methods :
6037
6038 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6039 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6040 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6041 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6042 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6043 of the client ranges may be used.
6044
6045 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6046 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6047 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6048 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6049 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6050 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6051 same session.
6052
6053 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6054 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6055 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6056 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6057 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6058 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6059
6060 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6061 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6062 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006063 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006064
6065 Examples :
6066 backend private
6067 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6068 source 192.168.1.200
6069
6070 backend transparent_ssl1
6071 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6072 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6073
6074 backend transparent_ssl2
6075 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6076 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6077 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6078
6079 backend transparent_ssl3
6080 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6081 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6082 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6083
6084 backend transparent_smtp
6085 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6086 # with Tproxy version 4.
6087 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6088
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006089 backend transparent_http
6090 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6091 # proxy.
6092 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006094 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006095 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006097
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006098srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6099 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6101 yes | no | yes | yes
6102 Arguments :
6103 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6104 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6105 as explained at the top of this document.
6106
6107 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6108 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6109 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6110 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6111 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6112 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6113 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6114
6115 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6116 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6117 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6118 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6119 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006120 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006121 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006122 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006123
6124 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6125 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6126 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6127 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6128 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6129 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6130
6131 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6132 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6133
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006134 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6135 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006136
6137
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006138stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6139 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006141 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006142
6143 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6144 matched.
6145
6146 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6147 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6148
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006149 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6150 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6151 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6152
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006153 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6154 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6155 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6156 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006157
6158 Example :
6159 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6160 backend stats_localhost
6161 stats enable
6162 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6163
6164 Example :
6165 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6166 backend stats_auth
6167 stats enable
6168 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6169 stats admin if TRUE
6170
6171 Example :
6172 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6173 userlist stats-auth
6174 group admin users admin
6175 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6176 group readonly users haproxy
6177 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6178
6179 backend stats_auth
6180 stats enable
6181 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6182 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6183 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6184 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6185
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006186 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6187 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6188 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006189
6190
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006191stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6192 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006194 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006195 Arguments :
6196 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6197
6198 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6199
6200 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6201 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6202 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6203 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6204 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6205 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6206
6207 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6208 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6209 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006210 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006211
6212 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6213 report using "stats scope".
6214
6215 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6216 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6217 unobvious parameters.
6218
6219 Example :
6220 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6221 backend public_www
6222 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6223 stats enable
6224 stats hide-version
6225 stats scope .
6226 stats uri /admin?stats
6227 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6228 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6229 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6230
6231 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6232 backend private_monitoring
6233 stats enable
6234 stats uri /admin?stats
6235 stats refresh 5s
6236
6237 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6238
6239
6240stats enable
6241 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006243 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6247 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6248 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6249 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6250 - stats auth : no authentication
6251 - stats scope : no restriction
6252
6253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6255 unobvious parameters.
6256
6257 Example :
6258 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6259 backend public_www
6260 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6261 stats enable
6262 stats hide-version
6263 stats scope .
6264 stats uri /admin?stats
6265 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6266 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6267 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6268
6269 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6270 backend private_monitoring
6271 stats enable
6272 stats uri /admin?stats
6273 stats refresh 5s
6274
6275 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6276
6277
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006278stats hide-version
6279 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006281 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006282 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006283
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006284 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6285 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6286 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6287 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6288 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6289 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006291 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6292 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6293 unobvious parameters.
6294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006295 Example :
6296 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6297 backend public_www
6298 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006299 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006300 stats hide-version
6301 stats scope .
6302 stats uri /admin?stats
6303 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6304 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6305 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006306
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006307 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6308 backend private_monitoring
6309 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310 stats uri /admin?stats
6311 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006312
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006313 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006314
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006315
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006316stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6317 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6318 Access control for statistics
6319
6320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 no | no | yes | yes
6322
6323 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6324 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6325 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6326 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6327 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6328 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6329
6330 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6331 instance.
6332
6333 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6334 about ACL usage.
6335
6336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006337stats realm <realm>
6338 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006341 Arguments :
6342 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6343 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6344 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6345
6346 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6347 using a backslash ('\').
6348
6349 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6350 only related to authentication.
6351
6352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6354 unobvious parameters.
6355
6356 Example :
6357 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6358 backend public_www
6359 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6360 stats enable
6361 stats hide-version
6362 stats scope .
6363 stats uri /admin?stats
6364 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6365 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6366 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6367
6368 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6369 backend private_monitoring
6370 stats enable
6371 stats uri /admin?stats
6372 stats refresh 5s
6373
6374 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6375
6376
6377stats refresh <delay>
6378 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006380 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006381 Arguments :
6382 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6383 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6384 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6385 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6386 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6387 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6388
6389 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6390 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6391 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6392 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6393
6394 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6395 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6396 unobvious parameters.
6397
6398 Example :
6399 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6400 backend public_www
6401 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6402 stats enable
6403 stats hide-version
6404 stats scope .
6405 stats uri /admin?stats
6406 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6407 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6408 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6409
6410 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6411 backend private_monitoring
6412 stats enable
6413 stats uri /admin?stats
6414 stats refresh 5s
6415
6416 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6417
6418
6419stats scope { <name> | "." }
6420 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006422 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006423 Arguments :
6424 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6425 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6426 section in which the statement appears.
6427
6428 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6429 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6430 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6431 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6432 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6433 exists.
6434
6435 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6436 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6437 unobvious parameters.
6438
6439 Example :
6440 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6441 backend public_www
6442 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6443 stats enable
6444 stats hide-version
6445 stats scope .
6446 stats uri /admin?stats
6447 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6448 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6449 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6450
6451 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6452 backend private_monitoring
6453 stats enable
6454 stats uri /admin?stats
6455 stats refresh 5s
6456
6457 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6458
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006459
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006460stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006461 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006463 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006464
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006465 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006466 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6467
6468 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6469 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6470
6471 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6472 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006473 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006474
6475 Example :
6476 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6477 backend private_monitoring
6478 stats enable
6479 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6480 stats uri /admin?stats
6481 stats refresh 5s
6482
6483 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6484 global section.
6485
6486
6487stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006488 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | yes | yes | yes
6491 Arguments : none
6492
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006493 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006494 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6495 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6496 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6497 - IP (socket, server)
6498 - cookie (backend, server)
6499
6500 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6501 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006502 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006503
6504 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6505
6506
6507stats show-node [ <name> ]
6508 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006510 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006511 Arguments:
6512 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6513 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6514
6515 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6516 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006517 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006518
6519 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6520 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6521 unobvious parameters.
6522
6523 Example:
6524 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6525 backend private_monitoring
6526 stats enable
6527 stats show-node Europe-1
6528 stats uri /admin?stats
6529 stats refresh 5s
6530
6531 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6532 section.
6533
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006534
6535stats uri <prefix>
6536 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006539 Arguments :
6540 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6541 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6542 query string.
6543
6544 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6545 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6546 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6547 possible to reach it in the application.
6548
6549 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006550 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006551 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6552 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6553 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6554 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6555
6556 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6557 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6558 an address or a port to statistics only.
6559
6560 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6561 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6562 unobvious parameters.
6563
6564 Example :
6565 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6566 backend public_www
6567 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6568 stats enable
6569 stats hide-version
6570 stats scope .
6571 stats uri /admin?stats
6572 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6573 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6574 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6575
6576 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6577 backend private_monitoring
6578 stats enable
6579 stats uri /admin?stats
6580 stats refresh 5s
6581
6582 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6583
6584
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006585stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6586 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006588 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006589
6590 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006591 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006592 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6593 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6594 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6595
6596 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6597 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6598 the "stick-table" statement.
6599
6600 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6601 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6602 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6603 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6604 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6605
6606 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6607 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6608 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6609 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6610 transformation rules.
6611
6612 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6613 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6614 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6615 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6616 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6617 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6618 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6619
6620 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6621 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6622 ACL based conditions.
6623
6624 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6625 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6626 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6627 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6628
6629 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6630 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6631 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6632 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6633
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006634 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6635 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6636 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6637
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006638 Example :
6639 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6640 # last 30 minutes
6641 backend pop
6642 mode tcp
6643 balance roundrobin
6644 stick store-request src
6645 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6646 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6647 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6648
6649 backend smtp
6650 mode tcp
6651 balance roundrobin
6652 stick match src table pop
6653 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6654 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6655
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006656 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006657 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006658
6659
6660stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6661 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6663 no | no | yes | yes
6664
6665 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6666 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6667 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6668 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6669
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006670 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6671 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6672 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6673
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006674 Examples :
6675 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006676 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006677
6678 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6679 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6680 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6681
6682
6683 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6684 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6685 backend http
6686 mode http
6687 balance roundrobin
6688 stick on src table https
6689 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6690 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6691 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6692
6693 backend https
6694 mode tcp
6695 balance roundrobin
6696 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6697 stick on src
6698 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6699 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6700
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006701 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006702
6703
6704stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6705 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 no | no | yes | yes
6708
6709 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006710 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006711 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6712 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6713 server is selected.
6714
6715 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6716 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6717 the "stick-table" statement.
6718
6719 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6720 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6721 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6722 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6723 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6724 address.
6725
6726 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6727 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6728 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6729 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6730 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6731 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6732 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6733 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6734 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6735 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6736
6737 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6738 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6739 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6740 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6741 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6742 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6743 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6744
6745 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6746 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6747 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6748 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6749
6750 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6751 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6752 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6753 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6754 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6755 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006756 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6757 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6758 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6759 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6760 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6761 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006762
6763 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6764 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6765 the request.
6766
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006767 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6768 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6769 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6770
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006771 Example :
6772 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6773 # last 30 minutes
6774 backend pop
6775 mode tcp
6776 balance roundrobin
6777 stick store-request src
6778 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6779 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6780 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6781
6782 backend smtp
6783 mode tcp
6784 balance roundrobin
6785 stick match src table pop
6786 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6787 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6788
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006789 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006790 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006791
6792
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006793stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006794 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6795 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006796 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006798 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006799
6800 Arguments :
6801 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6802 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6803 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6804 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6805
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006806 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6807 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6808 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6809 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6810
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006811 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6812 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6813 instance.
6814
6815 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6816 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6817 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6818 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6819 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6820 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006821 to 32 characters.
6822
6823 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6824 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6825 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006826 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006827 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6828 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006829
6830 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006831 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6832 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006833 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6834 increase.
6835
6836 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006837 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6838 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6839 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006840
6841 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6842 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6843 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6844 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6845 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6846 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6847 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6848 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6849 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6850 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6851 parameter (see below).
6852
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006853 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6854 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6855 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6856 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6857 soft restart.
6858
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006859 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6860
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006861 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6862 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6863 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6864 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6865 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006866 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006867 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6868 if not expiration delay is specified.
6869
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006870 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6871 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6872 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6873 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006874 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6875 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6876 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6877 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6878 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6879 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6880 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6881 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6882 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6883 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6884 types and their arguments.
6885
6886 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6887 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6888 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6889 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6890
6891 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6892 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6893 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6894 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6895
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006896 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6897 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6898 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6899 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6900 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6901 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6902
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006903 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6904 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6905 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6906 they were received.
6907
6908 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6909 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6910 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6911 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6912 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6913
6914 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6915 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6916 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6917 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6918 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6919
6920 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6921 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6922 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6923
6924 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6925 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6926 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6927 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6928 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6929
6930 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6931 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6932 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6933 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6934 the client side.
6935
6936 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6937 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6938 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6939 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6940 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6941 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6942 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6943
6944 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6945 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6946 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6947 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6948 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6949 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6950 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6951
6952 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6953 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6954 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6955 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6956 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6957 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6958
6959 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6960 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6961 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6962 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6963
6964 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6965 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6966 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6967 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6968 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6969 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6970 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6971 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6972 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6973 recommended for better fairness.
6974
6975 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6976 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6977 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6978 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6979
6980 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6981 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6982 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6983 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6984 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6985 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6986 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6987 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6988 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6989 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006990
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006991 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6992 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006993 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6994 reference it.
6995
6996 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6997 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6998 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6999 as an exclusive stickiness.
7000
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007001 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7002 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7003 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7004 something that can be ignored.
7005
7006 Example:
7007 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7008 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7009 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7010 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7011
7012 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007013 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007014
7015
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007016stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7017 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | no | yes | yes
7020
7021 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007022 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007023 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7024 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7025 server is selected.
7026
7027 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7028 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7029 the "stick-table" statement.
7030
7031 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7032 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7033 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7034 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7035
7036 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7037 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7038 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7039 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7040 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7041 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007042 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007043 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7044 rules.
7045
7046 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7047 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7048 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7049 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7050 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7051 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7052 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7053
7054 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7055 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7056 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7057 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7058
7059 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7060 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7061 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7062 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7063 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7064 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007065 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7066 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7067 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7068 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7069 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7070 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7071 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7072 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7073 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007074
7075 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7076
7077 Example :
7078 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7079 backend https
7080 mode tcp
7081 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007082 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007083 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007084
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007085 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7086 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7087
7088 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7089 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7090 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7091
7092 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7093 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007094
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007095 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7096 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7097 # at offset 44.
7098
7099 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7100 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7101
7102 # Learn on response if server hello.
7103 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007104
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007105 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7106 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7107
7108 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7109 extraction.
7110
7111
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007112tcp-check connect [params*]
7113 Opens a new connection
7114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 no | no | yes | yes
7116
7117 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7118 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7119 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7120
7121 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7122 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7123 of the sequence.
7124
7125 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7126 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7127 do.
7128
7129 Parameters :
7130 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7131 use the TCP connection.
7132
7133 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7134 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7135 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7136
7137 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7138
7139 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7140
7141 Examples:
7142 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7143 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7144 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7145 option tcp-check
7146 tcp-check connect
7147 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7148 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7149 tcp-check send \r\n
7150 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7151 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7152 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7153 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7154 tcp-check send \r\n
7155 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7156 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7157
7158 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7159 option tcp-check
7160 tcp-check connect port 110
7161 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7162 tcp-check connect port 143
7163 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7164 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7165
7166 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7167
7168
7169tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7170 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7171 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 no | no | yes | yes
7173
7174 Arguments :
7175 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7176 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7177 binary.
7178 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7179 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7180 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7181
7182 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7183 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7184 with the usual backslash ('\').
7185 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7186 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7187 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7188 used upper or lower case.
7189
7190
7191 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7192
7193 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7194 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7195 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7196 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7197 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7198 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7199 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7200 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7201
7202 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7203 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7204 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7205 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7206 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7207 expression.
7208
7209 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7210 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7211 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7212 this exact hexadecimal string.
7213 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7214
7215 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7216 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7217 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7218 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7219 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7220 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7221 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7222 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7223 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7224 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7225 the null character.
7226
7227 Examples :
7228 # perform a POP check
7229 option tcp-check
7230 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7231
7232 # perform an IMAP check
7233 option tcp-check
7234 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7235
7236 # look for the redis master server
7237 option tcp-check
7238 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7239 tcp-check expect +PONG
7240 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7241 tcp-check expect string role:master
7242 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7243 tcp-check expect string +OK
7244
7245
7246 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7247 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7248
7249
7250tcp-check send <data>
7251 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 no | no | yes | yes
7254
7255 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7256 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7257
7258 Examples :
7259 # look for the redis master server
7260 option tcp-check
7261 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7262 tcp-check expect string role:master
7263
7264 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7265 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7266
7267
7268tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7269 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7270 tcp health check
7271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7272 no | no | yes | yes
7273
7274 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7275 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7276 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7277 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7278 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7279 hexadecimal string.
7280 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7281
7282 Examples :
7283 # redis check in binary
7284 option tcp-check
7285 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7286 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7287
7288
7289 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7290 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7291
7292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007293tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7294 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007297 Arguments :
7298 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007299 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7300 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007303
7304 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7305 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007306 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7307 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7308 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7309 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7310 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7311 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007312
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007313 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7314 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7315 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7316 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007317
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007318 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007319 - accept :
7320 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7321 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7322 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007324 - reject :
7325 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7326 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7327 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7328 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7329 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7330 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7331 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7332 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7333 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7334 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7335 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7336 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007337
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007338 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7339 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7340 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7341 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7342 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7343 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7344 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7345 hosts.
7346
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007347 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7348 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7349 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7350 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7351 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7352 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7353 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7354 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7355 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7356 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7357 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7358
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007359 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007360 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7361 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7362 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007363 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7364 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007366 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7367 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7368 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7369 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7370 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007373 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007374 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007375 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7376 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7377 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7378 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007380 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7381 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7382 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7383 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007385 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7386 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7387 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7388 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7389 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007390 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7391 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7392 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7393 layer7 information is extracted.
7394
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007395 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7396 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7397 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7398 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7399 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007400
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007401 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7402 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7403 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007404
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007405 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7406 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7407 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007409 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007410 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007411 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007412
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007413 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7414 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7415 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007416
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007417 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007418 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7419 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007420
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007421 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7422
7423 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7424
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007427 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007428
7429
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7431 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007433 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007434 Arguments :
7435 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007436 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007437 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7438 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007439
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007440 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7443 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7444 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7445 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7446 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007447
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007448 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7449 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7450 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7451 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007452 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7453 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7454 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7455 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7456 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7457 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007458 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007459 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007461 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7462 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7463 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7464 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007465
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007466 Four types of actions are supported :
7467 - accept : the request is accepted
7468 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7469 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007470 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007472 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7473 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007474
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007475 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7476 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7477 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7478 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7479 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7480 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007482 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7484 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007486 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007487 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7488 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7489 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7490 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007491 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7492 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7493 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007494
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007495 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007496 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7497 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7498 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007499
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007500 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007501 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7502 # and reject everything else.
7503 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7504 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007505 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007506 tcp-request content reject
7507
7508 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007509 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7510 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7511 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007512 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007513
7514 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7515 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7516 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007517 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 tcp-request content reject
7519
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007520 Example:
7521 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7522 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007523 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007524
7525 Example:
7526 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7527 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007528 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007530 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7531 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7532
7533 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007534 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007535 # protecting all our sites
7536 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007537 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7538 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007539 ...
7540 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7541
7542 backend http_dynamic
7543 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007544 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007545 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007546 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7547 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7548 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007549 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007551 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007554
7555
7556tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7557 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007559 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007560 Arguments :
7561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7563 as explained at the top of this document.
7564
7565 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7566 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7567 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7568 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7569 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7570
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007571 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7572 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7573 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7574 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7575
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007576 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7577 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007578 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007579 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007580 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7581 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7582 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7583 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007584
7585 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7586 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7587 it pass through unaffected.
7588
7589 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7590 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7591 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007592 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007593 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7594 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007595 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7596 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7597 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007598
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007599 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007600 "timeout client".
7601
7602
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007603tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7604 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 no | no | yes | yes
7607 Arguments :
7608 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007609 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007610
7611 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7612
7613 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7614 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7615 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007616 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7617 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007618
7619 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7620
7621 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7622 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7623 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7624 inserted.
7625
7626 Two types of actions are supported :
7627 - accept :
7628 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7629 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7630 the rules evaluation.
7631
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007632 - close :
7633 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7634 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7635 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7636 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7637 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7638 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007639 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007640 protocols.
7641
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007642 - reject :
7643 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7644 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007645 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007646
7647 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7648 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7649 for changing the default action to a reject.
7650
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007651 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7652 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7653 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7654 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007655 period.
7656
7657 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7658
7659 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7660
7661
7662tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7663 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 no | no | yes | yes
7666 Arguments :
7667 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7668 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7669 as explained at the top of this document.
7670
7671 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7672
7673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007674timeout check <timeout>
7675 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7676 established.
7677
7678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 yes | no | yes | yes
7680 Arguments:
7681 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7682 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7683 as explained at the top of this document.
7684
7685 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7686 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7687 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7688 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007689 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7690 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7691 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007692
7693 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7694 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7695
7696 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7697 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007698 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007699
7700 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7701 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7702 forget about it.
7703
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007704 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7705 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007706
7707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007708timeout client <timeout>
7709timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7710 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | yes | yes | no
7713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007714 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7716 as explained at the top of this document.
7717
7718 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7719 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7720 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7721 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7722 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7723 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7724 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7725 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007726 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007727 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007728 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7729 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007730 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7731 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007732
7733 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7734 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7735 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7736 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7737 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7738 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7739
7740 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7741 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7742 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7743
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007744 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007745
7746
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007747timeout client-fin <timeout>
7748 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | yes | yes | no
7751 Arguments :
7752 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7753 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7754 as explained at the top of this document.
7755
7756 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7757 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7758 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7759 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7760 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7761 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7762 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7763 down in one direction.
7764
7765 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7766 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7767 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7768
7769 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7770
7771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007772timeout connect <timeout>
7773timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7774 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 yes | no | yes | yes
7777 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7780 as explained at the top of this document.
7781
7782 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007783 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007784 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007785 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007786 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7787 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007788
7789 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7790 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7791 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7792 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7793 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7794 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7795
7796 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7797 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7798 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7799
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007800 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7801 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007802
7803
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007804timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7805 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 yes | yes | yes | yes
7808 Arguments :
7809 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7810 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7811 as explained at the top of this document.
7812
7813 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7814 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7815 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7816 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7817 once the request has started to present itself.
7818
7819 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7820 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7821 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7822 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7823 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7824
7825 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7826 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7827 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7828 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7829
7830 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7831 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7832 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7833 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7834 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007835 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007836
7837 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7838 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7839 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7840 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7841
7842 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7843
7844
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007845timeout http-request <timeout>
7846 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7852 as explained at the top of this document.
7853
7854 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7855 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7856 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7857 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7858 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7859 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7860 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007861 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7862 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7863 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7864 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7865 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7866 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7867 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007868
7869 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7870 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007871 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7872 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007873
7874 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7875 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7876 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7877 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7878 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7879
7880 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007881 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7882 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7883 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007884
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007885 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007886
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007887
7888timeout queue <timeout>
7889 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | no | yes | yes
7892 Arguments :
7893 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7894 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7895 as explained at the top of this document.
7896
7897 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7898 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7899 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7900 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7901 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7902
7903 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7904 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7905 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7906 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7907
7908 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7909
7910
7911timeout server <timeout>
7912timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7913 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | no | yes | yes
7916 Arguments :
7917 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7918 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7919 as explained at the top of this document.
7920
7921 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7922 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7923 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7924 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7925 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7926 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7927 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7928
7929 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7930 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7931 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7932 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7933 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007934 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007935 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007936 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7937 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7938 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7939 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007940
7941 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7942 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7943 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7944 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7945 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7946 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7947
7948 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7949 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7950 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7951
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007952 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007953
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007954
7955timeout server-fin <timeout>
7956 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 yes | no | yes | yes
7959 Arguments :
7960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7962 as explained at the top of this document.
7963
7964 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7965 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7966 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7967 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7968 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7969 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7970 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7971 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7972 situations, it should not be needed.
7973
7974 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7975 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7976 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7977
7978 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7979
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007980
7981timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007982 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7984 yes | yes | yes | yes
7985 Arguments :
7986 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7987 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7988 as explained at the top of this document.
7989
7990 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7991 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7992 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7993
7994 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7995 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7996 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7997 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007998 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007999
8000 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8001
8002
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008003timeout tunnel <timeout>
8004 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8006 yes | no | yes | yes
8007 Arguments :
8008 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8009 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8010 as explained at the top of this document.
8011
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008012 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008013 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8014 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8015 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8016 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8017 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8018 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8019 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8020 specified.
8021
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008022 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8023 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8024 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8025 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8026 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8027 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8028 state.
8029
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008030 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8031 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8032 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8033 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8034 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8035
8036 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8037 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8038 forget about it.
8039
8040 Example :
8041 defaults http
8042 option http-server-close
8043 timeout connect 5s
8044 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008045 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008046 timeout server 30s
8047 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8048
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008049 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008050
8051
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008052transparent (deprecated)
8053 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008055 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008056 Arguments : none
8057
8058 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8059 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8060 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8061 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8062 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8063 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8064 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8065 appropriate server.
8066
8067 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8068
8069 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8070 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008072 See also: "option transparent"
8073
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008074unique-id-format <string>
8075 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8077 yes | yes | yes | no
8078 Arguments :
8079 <string> is a log-format string.
8080
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008081 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8082 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8083 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8084 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008085
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008086 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8087 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8088 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8089 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8090 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8091 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8092 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8093 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008094
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008095 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8096 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008097
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008098 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008099
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008100 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008101
8102 will generate:
8103
8104 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8105
8106 See also: "unique-id-header"
8107
8108unique-id-header <name>
8109 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 yes | yes | yes | no
8112 Arguments :
8113 <name> is the name of the header.
8114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008115 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8116 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008117
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008118 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008119
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008120 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008121 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8122
8123 will generate:
8124
8125 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8126
8127 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008128
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008129use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008130 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 no | yes | yes | no
8133 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008134 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8135 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008136
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008137 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8138 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008139
8140 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8141 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8142 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008143 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8144 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8145 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8146 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008147
8148 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8149 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8150 assign the backend.
8151
8152 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8153 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8154 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8155 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8156 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8157 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8158
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008159 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008160 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008161 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8162 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8163 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8164
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008165 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8166 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8167 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8168 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8169 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8170 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8171 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8172 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8173 cannot be forced from the request.
8174
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008175 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008176 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8177 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8178
8179 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8180 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008181
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008182
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008183use-server <server> if <condition>
8184use-server <server> unless <condition>
8185 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 no | no | yes | yes
8188 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008189 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008190
8191 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8192
8193 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8194 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8195 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8196
8197 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8198 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8199 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8200 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8201 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8202 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8203 matches will assign the server.
8204
8205 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8206 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8207 with the next rules until one matches.
8208
8209 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8210 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8211 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8212 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8213
8214 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8215 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8216 stripped.
8217
8218 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8219 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8220 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8221 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8222
8223 Example :
8224 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8225 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8226 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8227 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8228 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8229 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8230 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8231 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8232 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8233
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008234 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008235
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008236
82375. Bind and Server options
8238--------------------------
8239
8240The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8241depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8242settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8243written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8244described in this section.
8245
8246
82475.1. Bind options
8248-----------------
8249
8250The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8251as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8252no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8253parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8254while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8255provided immediately after the setting name.
8256
8257The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8258
8259accept-proxy
8260 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008261 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8262 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008263 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8264 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8265 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8266 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8267 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8268 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8269 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008270 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8271 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008272
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008273alpn <protocols>
8274 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8275 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8276 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8277 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8278 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8279 initial NPN extension.
8280
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008281backlog <backlog>
8282 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8283 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8284
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008285ecdhe <named curve>
8286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008287 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8288 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008289
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008290ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8292 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8293 client's certificate.
8294
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008295ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8297 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8298 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8299 error is ignored.
8300
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008301ciphers <ciphers>
8302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8303 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008304 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008305 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8306 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8307
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008308crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8310 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8311 to verify client's certificate.
8312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008313crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8315 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8316 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8317 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8318 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8319 file.
8320
8321 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8322 are loaded.
8323
8324 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008325 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8326 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008327 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8328 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8329 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8330 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8331 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8332 www.sub.example.org).
8333
8334 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8335 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8336 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8337 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8338 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8339
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008340 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008341
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008342 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8343 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008344 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008345 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8346 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8347 clients).
8348
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008349 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8350 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8351 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8352 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8353 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8354 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8355 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8356 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8357 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8358 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8359 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8360 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8361 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8362
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008363crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8365 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008366 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008367 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008368
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008369crt-list <file>
8370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008371 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8372 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008373
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008374 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008375
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008376 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8377 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8378 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8379 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8380 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8381 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8382 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8383 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008384
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008385defer-accept
8386 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8387 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8388 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8389 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8390 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8391 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8392 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8393 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8394 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8395 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8396 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8397
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008398force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008399 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008400 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008401 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8402 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008403
8404force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008405 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008406 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8407 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008408
8409force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008410 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008411 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8412 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008413
8414force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008415 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008416 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8417 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008419gid <gid>
8420 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8421 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8422 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8423 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8424 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8425
8426group <group>
8427 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8428 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8429 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8430 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8431 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8432
8433id <id>
8434 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8435 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8436 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8437 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8438
8439interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008440 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8441 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8442 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8443 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8444 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8445 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8446 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008447
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008448level <level>
8449 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8450 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8451 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8452 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8453 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8454 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8455 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8456 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8457 counters).
8458 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8459 all counters).
8460
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008461maxconn <maxconn>
8462 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8463 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8464 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8465 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8466 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8467 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8468 eat all memory.
8469
8470mode <mode>
8471 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8472 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8473 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8474 UNIX sockets.
8475
8476mss <maxseg>
8477 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8478 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8479 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8480 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8481 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8482 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8483 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8484 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8485 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8486 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8487 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8488
8489name <name>
8490 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8491 page.
8492
8493nice <nice>
8494 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8495 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8496 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8497 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8498 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8499 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8500 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8501 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8502 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8503 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8504 one for an RDP socket.
8505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008506no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008508 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008509 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008510 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8511 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008512 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008513
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008514no-tls-tickets
8515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8516 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8517 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008518 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8519 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008520
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008521no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008523 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008524 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008525 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8526 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8527 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008528
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008529no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008531 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008532 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008533 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8534 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8535 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008536
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008537no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008539 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008540 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008541 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8542 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8543 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008544
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008545npn <protocols>
8546 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8547 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8548 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8549 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008550 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8551 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008552
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008553process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8554 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8555 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8556 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8557 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8558 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8559 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8560 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008561 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8562 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8563 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8564 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8565 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8566 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8567 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008568
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008569ssl
8570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008571 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008572 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8573 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8574 to deciphered contents.
8575
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008576strict-sni
8577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8578 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8579 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8580 See the "crt" option for more information.
8581
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008582tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008583 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008584 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8585 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8586 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8587 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8588 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8589 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8590 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008591 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8592 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8593 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008594
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008595transparent
8596 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8597 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8598 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8599 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8600 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8601 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8602 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8603 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8604 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8605 so check for support with your vendor.
8606
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008607v4v6
8608 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8609 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8610 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8611 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008612 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008613
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008614v6only
8615 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8616 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8617 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008618 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8619 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008621uid <uid>
8622 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8623 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8624 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8625 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8626 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8627
8628user <user>
8629 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8630 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8631 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8632 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8633 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8634
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008635verify [none|optional|required]
8636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8637 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8638 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8639 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8640 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008641 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8642 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8643 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8644 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008645
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086465.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008647------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008649The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8650which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8651arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8652settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8653after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8654Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8655address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008657 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008658 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008660The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008661
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008662addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008663 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8664 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8665 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8666 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8667 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008669 Supported in default-server: No
8670
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008671agent-check
8672 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008673 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8674 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8675 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8676 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008677
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008678 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008679 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008680 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8681 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8682 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008683
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008684 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8685 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008686
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008687 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8688 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8689 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008690
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008691 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8692 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8693 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008694
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008695 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8696 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8697 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8698 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8699 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8700 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8701 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008702
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008703 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8704 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008705
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008706 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8707 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8708 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8709 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8710 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8711 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8712 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8713 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8714 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008715
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008716 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8717 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008718 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8719 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8720 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8721 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008722
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008723 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8724 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008725
8726 Supported in default-server: No
8727
8728agent-inter <delay>
8729 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8730 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8731
8732 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8733 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8734 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8735 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8736 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8737 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8738 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8739 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8740 of backends use the same servers.
8741
8742 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8743
8744 Supported in default-server: Yes
8745
8746agent-port <port>
8747 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8748
8749 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8750
8751 Supported in default-server: Yes
8752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753backup
8754 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8755 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8756 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8757 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8758 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8759 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008761 Supported in default-server: No
8762
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008763ca-file <cafile>
8764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8765 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8766 server's certificate.
8767
8768 Supported in default-server: No
8769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008770check
8771 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008772 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8773 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8774 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8775 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8776 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8777 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8778 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008779 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8780 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8781 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008783 Supported in default-server: No
8784
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008785check-send-proxy
8786 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8787 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8788 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8789 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8790 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8791 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8792 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8793
8794 Supported in default-server: No
8795
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008796check-ssl
8797 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8798 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8799 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8800 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008801 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008802 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8803 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8804 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8805 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8806
8807 Supported in default-server: No
8808
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008809ciphers <ciphers>
8810 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008811 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008812 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8813 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8814 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8815 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8816 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8817 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8818
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008819 Supported in default-server: No
8820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008821cookie <value>
8822 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8823 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8824 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8825 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8826 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8827 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8828 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008830 Supported in default-server: No
8831
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008832crl-file <crlfile>
8833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8834 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8835 to verify server's certificate.
8836
8837 Supported in default-server: No
8838
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008839crt <cert>
8840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8841 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8842 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8843 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8844 certificate request.
8845
8846 Supported in default-server: No
8847
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008848disabled
8849 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8850 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8851 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8852 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8853 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8854
8855 Supported in default-server: No
8856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008857error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008858 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8859 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8860 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008862 Supported in default-server: Yes
8863
8864 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008866fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008867 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8868 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8869 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008871 Supported in default-server: Yes
8872
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008873force-sslv3
8874 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8875 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008876 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8877 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008878
8879 Supported in default-server: No
8880
8881force-tlsv10
8882 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008883 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8884 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008885
8886 Supported in default-server: No
8887
8888force-tlsv11
8889 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008890 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8891 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008892
8893 Supported in default-server: No
8894
8895force-tlsv12
8896 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008897 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8898 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008899
8900 Supported in default-server: No
8901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008902id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008903 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8904 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8905 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008907 Supported in default-server: No
8908
8909inter <delay>
8910fastinter <delay>
8911downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008912 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8913 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8914 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8915 between checks depending on the server state :
8916
8917 Server state | Interval used
8918 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8919 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8920 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8921 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8922 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8923 or yet unchecked. |
8924 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8925 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8926 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008928 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8929 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8930 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8931 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008932 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8933 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8934 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8935 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8936 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008938 Supported in default-server: Yes
8939
8940maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008941 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8942 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8943 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8944 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8945 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8946 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8947 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8948 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008950 Supported in default-server: Yes
8951
8952maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008953 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8954 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8955 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8956 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8957 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8958 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8959 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008961 Supported in default-server: Yes
8962
8963minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008964 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8965 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8966 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8967 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8968 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8969 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008970 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008971 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008973 Supported in default-server: Yes
8974
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008975no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008976 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8977 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008978 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008979
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008980 Supported in default-server: No
8981
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008982no-tls-tickets
8983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8984 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8985 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008986 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
8987 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008988
8989 Supported in default-server: No
8990
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008991no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008992 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008993 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8994 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008995 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
8996 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
8997 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008998
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008999 Supported in default-server: No
9000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009001no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009002 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9004 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009005 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9006 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9007 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009008
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009009 Supported in default-server: No
9010
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009011no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009012 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009013 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9014 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009015 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9016 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9017 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009018
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009019 Supported in default-server: No
9020
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009021non-stick
9022 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9023 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9024 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9025
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009026 Supported in default-server: No
9027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009028observe <mode>
9029 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9030 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9031 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9032 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9033 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9034 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009035 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009037 Supported in default-server: No
9038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009039 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009041on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009042 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9043 Currently, four modes are available:
9044 - fastinter: force fastinter
9045 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9046 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9047 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9048 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009050 Supported in default-server: Yes
9051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009052 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9053
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009054on-marked-down <action>
9055 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9056 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009057 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9058 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9059 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9060 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9061 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9062 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9063 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9064 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009065
9066 Actions are disabled by default
9067
9068 Supported in default-server: Yes
9069
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009070on-marked-up <action>
9071 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9072 Currently one action is available:
9073 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9074 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9075 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9076 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9077 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9078 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9079 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9080 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9081
9082 Actions are disabled by default
9083
9084 Supported in default-server: Yes
9085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009086port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009087 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9088 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9089 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9090 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9091 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9092 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009094 Supported in default-server: Yes
9095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009096redir <prefix>
9097 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9098 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9099 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9100 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9101 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9102 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9103 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9104 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009105 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9107 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9108 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9109 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9110 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9111
9112 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009114 Supported in default-server: No
9115
9116rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009117 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9118 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9119 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009121 Supported in default-server: Yes
9122
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009123send-proxy
9124 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9125 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9126 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9127 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9128 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9129 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9130 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9131 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9132 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009133 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9134 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9135 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9136 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9137 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009138
9139 Supported in default-server: No
9140
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009141send-proxy-v2
9142 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9143 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9144 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9145 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9146 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9147 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9148 option of the "bind" keyword.
9149
9150 Supported in default-server: No
9151
9152send-proxy-v2-ssl
9153 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9154 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9155 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9156 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9157 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9158 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9159 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9160 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9161
9162 Supported in default-server: No
9163
9164send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9165 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9166 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9167 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9168 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9169 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9170 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9171 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9172 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9173 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9174
9175 Supported in default-server: No
9176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009177slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009178 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9179 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9180 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9181 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9182 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9183 parameters :
9184
9185 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9186 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9187
9188 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9189 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9190 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9191 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9192
9193 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9194 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9195 seen as failed.
9196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009197 Supported in default-server: Yes
9198
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009199source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009200source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009201source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009202 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9203 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9204 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9205 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9206
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009207 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9208 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9209 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9210 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9211 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9212 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9213 server.
9214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009215 Supported in default-server: No
9216
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009217ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009218 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9219 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9220 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9221 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9222 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9223 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009224 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009225
9226 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009228track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009229 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9230 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9231 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9232 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009233 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009235 Supported in default-server: No
9236
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009237verify [none|required]
9238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009239 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9240 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9241 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9242 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009243 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9244 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9245 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009246
9247 Supported in default-server: No
9248
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009249verifyhost <hostname>
9250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9251 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9252 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9253 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9254 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9255 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9256
9257 Supported in default-server: No
9258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009259weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009260 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9261 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9262 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009263 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9264 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9265 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9266 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9267 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9268 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009270 Supported in default-server: Yes
9271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009272
92736. HTTP header manipulation
9274---------------------------
9275
9276In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9277response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9278request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9279which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009280against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009281
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009282If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9283to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9284but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9285HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9286stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9287because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9288a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9289still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9292in section 4.2 :
9293
9294 - reqadd <string>
9295 - reqallow <search>
9296 - reqiallow <search>
9297 - reqdel <search>
9298 - reqidel <search>
9299 - reqdeny <search>
9300 - reqideny <search>
9301 - reqpass <search>
9302 - reqipass <search>
9303 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9304 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9305 - reqtarpit <search>
9306 - reqitarpit <search>
9307 - rspadd <string>
9308 - rspdel <search>
9309 - rspidel <search>
9310 - rspdeny <search>
9311 - rspideny <search>
9312 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9313 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9314
9315With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9316is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9317parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9318prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9319Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9320
9321 \t for a tab
9322 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9323 \n for a new line (LF)
9324 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9325 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9326 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9327 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9328 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9329
9330The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9331portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9332above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9333regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93349 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9335is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9336
9337The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9338after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9339
9340Notes related to these keywords :
9341---------------------------------
9342 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9343 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9344 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9345
9346 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9347 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9348 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9349
9350 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9351 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9352 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9353 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9354 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9355
9356 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9357 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9358 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9359 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9360 useless headers before adding new ones.
9361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009362 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009363 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9364
9365 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9366 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9367 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9368
9369 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9370 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009371 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009372
9373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9375----------------------------------
9376
9377Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9378client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9379The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9380these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9381but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9382data called patterns.
9383
9384
93857.1. ACL basics
9386---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009387
9388The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9389content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9390from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9391simple :
9392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009393 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009394 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009395 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9396 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9399adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009400
9401In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009403 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009404
9405This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9406Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9407and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009408an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9409conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9410as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9411are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009412
9413ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9414'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9415which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9416
9417There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9418performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009420The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9421specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9422this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009423methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9424ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425
9426Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9427 - boolean
9428 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9429 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9430 - string
9431 - data block
9432
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009433Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9434converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9435would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9436The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9437which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9438
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009439Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9440keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9441fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9442which are summarized in the table below :
9443
9444 +---------------------+-----------------+
9445 | Sample or converter | Default |
9446 | output type | matching method |
9447 +---------------------+-----------------+
9448 | boolean | bool |
9449 +---------------------+-----------------+
9450 | integer | int |
9451 +---------------------+-----------------+
9452 | ip | ip |
9453 +---------------------+-----------------+
9454 | string | str |
9455 +---------------------+-----------------+
9456 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9457 +---------------------+-----------------+
9458
9459Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9460matching method, see below.
9461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009462The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9463 - boolean
9464 - integer or integer range
9465 - IP address / network
9466 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9467 - regular expression
9468 - hex block
9469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009470The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9471
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009472 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9473 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009474 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009475 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009476 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009477 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009478 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009480The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9481read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9482if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9483lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9484will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9485beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9486a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9487lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9488exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9489
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009490The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9491parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9492ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9493a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9494check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9495
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009496The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9497socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9498file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9501loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9502
9503 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9504
9505In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9506the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9507case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9508as well.
9509
9510The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9511sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9512do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9513methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9514is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9515obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9516followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9517default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9518that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9519string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9520
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009521The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9522By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9523string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9524resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9525server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9526waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9527flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9528function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009530There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9531sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9532be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009533
9534 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9535 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9537 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9538 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9539 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009540
9541 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9542 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009543 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009544
9545 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009546 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009547
9548 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009550
9551 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9552 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9553
9554 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9555 binary or string samples.
9556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009557 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9558 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9561 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9562 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9565 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9568 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9571 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009573 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9574 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009575 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009577 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9578 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9579 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009580
9581For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9582request, it is possible to do :
9583
9584 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9585
9586In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9587buffer, one would use the following acl :
9588
9589 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9590
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009591On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9592possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9593
9594 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009596All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9597criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9598method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9599to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9600criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9601the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009603If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009604the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9605For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009607 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9608 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9609 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9610 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009611
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009612
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009613The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9614types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9615combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9616brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9617default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009619 +-------------------------------------------------+
9620 | Input sample type |
9621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009622 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9624 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009626 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009628 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009630 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009632 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009634 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009636 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009638 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009640 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009642 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009644 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009646 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9648 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009650
9651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096527.1.1. Matching booleans
9653------------------------
9654
9655In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9656Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9657When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9658that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9659
9660Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9661return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9662"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9663
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096657.1.2. Matching integers
9666------------------------
9667
9668Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9669enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9670to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9671
9672Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9673matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9674lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009675
9676For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9677unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9678representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9679
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009680As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9681two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9682instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9683ranges and operators.
9684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009685For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009686operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9687Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9688of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009690Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009691
9692 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9693 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9694 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9695 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9696 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9697
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009698For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009699
9700 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9701
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009702This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9703
9704 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097077.1.3. Matching strings
9708-----------------------
9709
9710String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9711different forms :
9712
9713 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9714 patterns ;
9715
9716 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9717 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9718
9719 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9720 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9721
9722 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9723 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9724
9725 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9726 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9727 matches.
9728
9729 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9730 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9731 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009732
9733String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9734exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9735characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9736string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9737to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009739
9740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097417.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9742---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009743
9744Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9745they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9746possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9747passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9748the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009749the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9750match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009751
9752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097537.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9754-------------------------------------
9755
9756It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9757not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9758a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9759to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9760digits may be used upper or lower case.
9761
9762Example :
9763 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9764 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9765
9766
97677.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9768---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009769
9770IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9771netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9772within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009773host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009774difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9775at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9776does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9777parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009778
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009779IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9780Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9781trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9782IPv6 patterns.
9783
9784HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9785following situations :
9786 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9787 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9788 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9789 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9790 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9791 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9792 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9793 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9794 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9795 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009797
97987.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9799----------------------------------
9800
9801Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9802combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9803
9804 - AND (implicit)
9805 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9806 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009810 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009812Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9813indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9816"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9817requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9818is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9819
9820 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9821 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9822 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9823 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9824
9825To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9826and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9827
9828 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9829 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9830 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9831 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9832
9833 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9834 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9835 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9836 use_backend www if host_www
9837
9838It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9839expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9840be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9841the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9842
9843 The following rule :
9844
9845 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9846 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9847
9848 Can also be written that way :
9849
9850 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9851
9852It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9853to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9854simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9855sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9856good use is the following :
9857
9858 With named ACLs :
9859
9860 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9861 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9862 monitor fail if site_dead
9863
9864 With anonymous ACLs :
9865
9866 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9867
9868See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9869
9870
98717.3. Fetching samples
9872---------------------
9873
9874Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9875against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9876sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9877ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9878of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9879available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9880
9881This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9882Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9883compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9884deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9885
9886The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9887matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9888method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9889indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9890
9891As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9892when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9893mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9894the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9895ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9896
9897Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9898multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9899when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9900incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9901are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9902is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9903all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9904
9905Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9906 - name
9907 - name(arg1)
9908 - name(arg1,arg2)
9909
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009910
99117.3.1. Converters
9912-----------------
9913
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009914Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9915of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9916is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9917was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9918has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9919unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9920
9921These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9922sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9923the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9924support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009927
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009928base64
9929 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9930 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9931 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9932
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009933hex
9934 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9935 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9936 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9937 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009938
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009939http_date([<offset>])
9940 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9941 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9942 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9943 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9944 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9945 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009947ipmask(<mask>)
9948 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9949 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9950 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9951 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9952
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009953language(<value>[,<default>])
9954 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9955 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9956 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9957 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9958 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9959 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9960 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9961 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9962 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9963 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9964 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9965 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009967 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009968
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009969 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9970 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009972 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9973 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9974 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9975 use_backend spanish if es
9976 use_backend french if fr
9977 use_backend english if en
9978 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009979
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009980lower
9981 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9982 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9983 type. The result is of type string.
9984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009985map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9986map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9987map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9988 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9989 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9990 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9991 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9992 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9993 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9994 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9995 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009996
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009997 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9998 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9999 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010001 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10002 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010004 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10005 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10006 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10007 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010008 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10009 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010010 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10011 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10012 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10013 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10014 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10015 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10016 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10018 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10020 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10022 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010025 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10026 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10027 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10028 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10029 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010031 Example :
10032
10033 # this is a comment and is ignored
10034 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10035 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10036 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10037 | | | `---------- value
10038 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10039 | `---------------------------- key
10040 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10041
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010042upper
10043 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10044 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10045 type. The result is of type string.
10046
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010047
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100487.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010049--------------------------------------------
10050
10051A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10052not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10053"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10054The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10055
10056always_false : boolean
10057 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10058 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10059
10060always_true : boolean
10061 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10062 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10063
10064avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010065 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10067 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10068 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10069 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10070 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10071 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10072 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10073 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10074 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10075 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10076 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10077 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10078 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010081 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10082 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10083 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10084 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10085 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10089 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10090 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10091 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10092 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10093 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010094
10095 Example :
10096 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10097 backend dynamic
10098 mode http
10099 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10100 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10103 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010104 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10106 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010107
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010108 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010109 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010110 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10111
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010112 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10113 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010114
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010115 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010116 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010117 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010118 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10119 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010121 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010122
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010123 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10124 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010125 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010126 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010127
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010128date([<offset>]) : integer
10129 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10130 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10131 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10132 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010133 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10134
10135 Example :
10136
10137 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10138 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010139
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010140env(<name>) : string
10141 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10142 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10143 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10144 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10145 certain way.
10146
10147 Examples :
10148 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10149 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10150
10151 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10152 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10155 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010156 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10157 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010158 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10159 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10160 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10161 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10162 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10166 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10167 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10168 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10169 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10170 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10171 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10172 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010173
10174 Example :
10175 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10176 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10177 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10178 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10179 frontend mail
10180 bind :25
10181 mode tcp
10182 maxconn 100
10183 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10184 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10185 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10186 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010187
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010188nbproc : integer
10189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10190 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10191 and debugging purposes.
10192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010193nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10195 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10196 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010197 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10198 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10199 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010200
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010201proc : integer
10202 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10203 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10204 debugging purposes.
10205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010207 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10208 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10209 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10211 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10212 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10213 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10214 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10215
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010216rand([<range>]) : integer
10217 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10218 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10219 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10220 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10221 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10225 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10226 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10227 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10228 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10229 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10230 methods.
10231
10232srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10233 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10234 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10235 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10236 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10237 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10238 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10239 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10240
10241srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10242 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10243 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010244 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010245 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10246 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10247 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10248 overloading servers).
10249
10250 Example :
10251 # Redirect to a separate back
10252 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10253 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10254 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10255
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010256stopping : boolean
10257 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10258 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10259 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10262 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10263 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10264
10265table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10266 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10267 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10268 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10269
10270
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272----------------------------------
10273
10274The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10275closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10276methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10277sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10278TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010279the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10280counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10281"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010282argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10283the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10284this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285
10286be_id : integer
10287 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10288 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10289
10290dst : ip
10291 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10292 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10293 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10294 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10295 RFC 4291.
10296
10297dst_conn : integer
10298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10299 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10300 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10301 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10302 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10303 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10304 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10305 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010307dst_port : integer
10308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10309 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10310 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10311 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10312 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10313 an HTTP header.
10314
10315fe_id : integer
10316 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10317 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10318 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010320sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010321sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10322sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10323sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010324 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10325 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10326 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010328sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010329sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10330sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10331sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010332 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10333 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10334 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010336sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010337sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10338sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10339sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010340 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10341 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010342 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10343 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10344 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010345
10346 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10347 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010348 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10349 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10350 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010351 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10352 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010354sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010355sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10356sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10357sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10359 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010361sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010362sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10363sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10364sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010365 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10366 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10367 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010369sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010370sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10371sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10372sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010373 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10374 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10375 See also src_conn_rate.
10376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010377sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010378sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10379sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10380sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010381 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010382 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010384sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010385sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10386sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10387sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010388 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10389 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10390 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010391 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10392 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10393 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010395sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010396sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10397sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10398sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010399 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10400 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10401 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010403sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010404sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10405sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10406sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10408 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10409 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10410 src_http_err_rate.
10411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010412sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010413sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10414sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10415sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010416 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10417 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10418 src_http_req_cnt.
10419
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010420sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010421sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10422sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10423sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010424 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10425 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10426 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10427 src_http_req_rate.
10428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010429sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010430sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10431sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10432sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010433 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010434 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10435 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10436 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10437 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010438
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010439 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10440 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010441 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010443sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010444sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10445sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10446sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010447 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10448 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10449 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010451sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010452sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10453sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10454sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010455 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10456 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10457 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010459sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010460sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10461sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10462sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10464 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10465 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10466 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010467 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010468 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010470sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010471sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10472sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10473sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010474 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10475 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10476 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10477 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10478 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010479 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010480
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010481sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010482sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10483sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10484sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010485 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10486 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10487 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010489sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010490sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10491sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10492sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010493 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10494 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010495 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010496 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10497 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010498 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10499 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10500 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010502so_id : integer
10503 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10504 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10505 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010507src : ip
10508 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10509 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10510 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10511 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10512 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10513 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10514 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010515
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010516 Example:
10517 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10518 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010520src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10521 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10522 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10523 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010524 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10527 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10528 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010529 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010530 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10533 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10534 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10535 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10536 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10537 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10538 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010539
10540 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10541 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10542 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10543 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010544 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010545 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10546 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010548src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010549 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010551 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010552 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010555 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10557 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010558 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10561 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10562 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10563 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010564 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010567 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010568 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010569 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010570 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010573 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010575 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10576 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010577 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10578 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10579 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10582 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10583 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010584 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010585 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10589 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10590 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10591 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10592 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010593 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10596 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10597 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10598 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010599 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10602 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10603 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10604 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010605 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010606 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10609 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10610 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10611 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010612 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10614 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010615
10616 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010617 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010618 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010621 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10622 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10623 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10624 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10625 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010628 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10629 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10630 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10631 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10632 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634src_port : integer
10635 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10636 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10637 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10638 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10641 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010642 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10643 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10644 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010645 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010647src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10648 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10649 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10650 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10651 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010652 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010654src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10655 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10656 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10657 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10658 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10659 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10660 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10661 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10662 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010663
10664 Example :
10665 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10666 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10667 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10668 listen ssh
10669 bind :22
10670 mode tcp
10671 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010672 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010673 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010674 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010676srv_id : integer
10677 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10678 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10679 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010680
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010681
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010685The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10686closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10687when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10688usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010689future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010690
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010691ssl_bc : boolean
10692 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10693 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10694 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10695
10696ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10697 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10698 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10699
10700ssl_bc_cipher : string
10701 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10702 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10703
10704ssl_bc_protocol : string
10705 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10706 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10707
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010708ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010709 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010710 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10711 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010712
10713ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10714 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10715 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10716 if session was reused or not.
10717
10718ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10719 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10720 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010722ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10723 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10724 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10725 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10726 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10727 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10730 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10731 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10732 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10733 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010734
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010735ssl_c_der : binary
10736 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10737 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10738 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740ssl_c_err : integer
10741 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10742 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10743 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10744 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10745 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010747ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10748 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10749 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10750 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10751 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10752 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10753 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10754 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10755 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757ssl_c_key_alg : string
10758 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10759 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10760 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762ssl_c_notafter : string
10763 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10764 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10765 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767ssl_c_notbefore : string
10768 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10769 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10770 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010772ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10773 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10774 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10775 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10776 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10777 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10778 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10779 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10780 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010782ssl_c_serial : binary
10783 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10784 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10785 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10788 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10789 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10790 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010791 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10792 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10793
10794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010796ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10797 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10798 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10799 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010801ssl_c_used : boolean
10802 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10803 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010805ssl_c_verify : integer
10806 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10807 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10808 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10809 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010811ssl_c_version : integer
10812 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10813 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010814
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010815ssl_f_der : binary
10816 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10817 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10818 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010820ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10821 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10822 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10823 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10824 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010825 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10827 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10828 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_f_key_alg : string
10831 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10832 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10833 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835ssl_f_notafter : string
10836 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10837 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10838 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840ssl_f_notbefore : string
10841 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10842 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10843 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10846 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10847 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10848 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10849 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10850 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10851 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10852 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10853 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855ssl_f_serial : binary
10856 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10857 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10858 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010859
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010860ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10861 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10862 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10863 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010865ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10867 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10868 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870ssl_f_version : integer
10871 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10872 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10873
10874ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010875 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10876 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10877 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879 Example :
10880 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10881 listen http-https
10882 bind :80
10883 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10884 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10885
10886ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10887 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10888 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10889
10890ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010891 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10893 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10894 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10895 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10896 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10897 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10898 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10899 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010901ssl_fc_cipher : string
10902 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10903 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010905ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010906 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10907 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010908 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10909 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10910 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10911 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10914 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010915 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10916 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10917 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10918 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010920ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010921 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10923 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10924 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10925 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10926 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10927 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10928 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930ssl_fc_protocol : string
10931 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10932 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010933
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010934ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010935 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010936 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10937 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10940 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10941 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10942 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10943 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945ssl_fc_sni : string
10946 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10947 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10948 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10949 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10950 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10951
10952 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10953 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10954 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010955 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10956 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010958 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10960 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10963 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10964 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010965
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109677.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10971sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10972only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10973For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10974be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10975can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10976sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10977for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10978content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10981 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10982 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10983 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010985payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10986 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10987 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10988 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990req.len : integer
10991req_len : integer (deprecated)
10992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10993 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10994 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10995 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10996 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10997 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10998 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10999 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11002 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011003 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11004 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11005 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11006 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011008 ACL alternatives :
11009 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11012 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11013 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11014 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11015 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 ACL alternatives :
11018 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011020 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022req.proto_http : boolean
11023req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11024 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11025 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11026 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11027 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11028 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11029 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11030 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011032 Example:
11033 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11034 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11035 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011036 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11039rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11040 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11041 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11042 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11043 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11044 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11045 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11046 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11049 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11050 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11051 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11052 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11053 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011055 ACL derivatives :
11056 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 Example :
11059 listen tse-farm
11060 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11061 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11062 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11063 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11064 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11065 persist rdp-cookie
11066 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11067 # This is only useful makes sense if
11068 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11069 stick-table type string size 204800
11070 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11071 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11072 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011074 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11075 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11078rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11079 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11080 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11081 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11082 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 ACL derivatives :
11085 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011087req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11088req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11089 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11090 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11091 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11092 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11093 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11094 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11095 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097req.ssl_sni : string
11098req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11099 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11100 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11101 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11102 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11103 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11104 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11105 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11106 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11107 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11108 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11109 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11110 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112 ACL derivatives :
11113 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115 Examples :
11116 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11117 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11118 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11119 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11120 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11123rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11124 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11125 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11126 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11127 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11128 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11129 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11130 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132req.ssl_ver : integer
11133req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11134 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11135 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11136 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11137 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11138 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11139 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11140 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11141 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11142 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144 ACL derivatives :
11145 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011146
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011147res.len : integer
11148 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11149 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11150 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11151 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11152 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11153 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11154 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11155 content inspection.
11156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11158 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011159 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11160 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11161 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11162 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011164res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11165 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11166 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11167 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11168 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011172wait_end : boolean
11173 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11174 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11175 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11176 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11177 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11178 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11179 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11180 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182 Examples :
11183 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11184 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11185 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11188 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11189 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11190 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11191 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11192 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11193 tcp-request content reject
11194
11195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111967.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197--------------------------------------
11198
11199It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11200This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11201data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11202its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11203HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11204content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11205to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11206more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11207response are indexed.
11208
11209base : string
11210 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11211 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11212 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11213 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11214 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11215 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11216 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11217 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11218
11219 ACL derivatives :
11220 base : exact string match
11221 base_beg : prefix match
11222 base_dir : subdir match
11223 base_dom : domain match
11224 base_end : suffix match
11225 base_len : length match
11226 base_reg : regex match
11227 base_sub : substring match
11228
11229base32 : integer
11230 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11231 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11232 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11233 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11234
11235base32+src : binary
11236 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11237 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11238 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11239 per-URL counters.
11240
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011241capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11242 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11243 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11244 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11245
11246capture.req.method : string
11247 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11248 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11249 because it's allocated.
11250
11251capture.req.uri : string
11252 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11253 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11254 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11255 allocated.
11256
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011257capture.req.ver : string
11258 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11259 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11260 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11261
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011262capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11263 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11264 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11265 The first entry is an index of 0.
11266 See also: "capture response header"
11267
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011268capture.res.ver : string
11269 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11270 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11271 persistent flag.
11272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273req.cook([<name>]) : string
11274cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11275 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11276 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11277 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11278 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11279 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11280 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11281 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11282 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11283
11284 ACL derivatives :
11285 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11286 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11287 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11288 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11289 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11290 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11291 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11292 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11295cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11296 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11297 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11300cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11301 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11302 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11303 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11304 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11308 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11309 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11310 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11311 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11312 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11313 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11314 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11315 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11316 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011318hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11319 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11320 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11321 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11322 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011323 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11326 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11327 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11328 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11329 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11330 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11331 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11332 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11333 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11336 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11337 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11338 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11339 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11342 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11343 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11344 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11345 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11346 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11347 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11348 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11349 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11350 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11351 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11352 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354 ACL derivatives :
11355 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11356 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11357 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11358 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11359 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11360 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11361 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11362 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11363
11364req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11365hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11367 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11368 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11369 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11370 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11371 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11372 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11373 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11374 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11375
11376req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11377hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11378 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11379 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11380 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11381 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11382 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11383 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11384 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11385 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11386
11387req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11388hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11389 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11390 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11391 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11392 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11393 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11394 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11395 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11396
11397http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11398 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11399 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11400 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11401 basic auth is supported.
11402
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011403http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11404 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11405 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11406 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11407 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11409 basic auth is supported.
11410
11411 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011412 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11413 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11414 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11415 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416
11417http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011418 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11419 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11421 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423method : integer + string
11424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11425 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11426 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11427 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11428 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11429 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11430 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432 ACL derivatives :
11433 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435 Example :
11436 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11437 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11438 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440path : string
11441 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11442 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11443 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11444 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11445 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11446 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11447 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449 ACL derivatives :
11450 path : exact string match
11451 path_beg : prefix match
11452 path_dir : subdir match
11453 path_dom : domain match
11454 path_end : suffix match
11455 path_len : length match
11456 path_reg : regex match
11457 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459req.ver : string
11460req_ver : string (deprecated)
11461 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11462 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11463 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465 ACL derivatives :
11466 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011468res.comp : boolean
11469 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11470 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11471 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011473res.comp_algo : string
11474 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11475 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11476 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478res.cook([<name>]) : string
11479scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11480 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11481 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11482 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484 ACL derivatives :
11485 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11488scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11489 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11490 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11491 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11494scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11496 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11497 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11500 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11501 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11502 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11503 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11504 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11505 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11506 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11507 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11508 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11511 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11512 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11513 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11514 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11515 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11518shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11520 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11521 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11522 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11523 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11524 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11525 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11526 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011528 ACL derivatives :
11529 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11530 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11531 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11532 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11533 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11534 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11535 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11536 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11537
11538res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11539shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11540 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11541 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11542 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11543 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11544 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11547shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11549 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11550 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11551 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11552 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11553 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11556shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11557 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11558 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11559 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11560 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11561 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11562 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564res.ver : string
11565resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11566 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11567 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569 ACL derivatives :
11570 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011572set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11574 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11575 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11576 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011578 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11579 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011583status : integer
11584 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11585 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11586 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011588url : string
11589 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11590 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11591 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11592 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11593 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11594 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11595 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011597 ACL derivatives :
11598 url : exact string match
11599 url_beg : prefix match
11600 url_dir : subdir match
11601 url_dom : domain match
11602 url_end : suffix match
11603 url_len : length match
11604 url_reg : regex match
11605 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011607url_ip : ip
11608 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11609 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11610 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11611 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11612 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11613 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11614 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616url_port : integer
11617 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11618 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11619 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11620 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11623url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11624 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11625 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11626 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11627 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11628 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11629 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11630 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11631 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11632 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634 ACL derivatives :
11635 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11636 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11637 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11638 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11639 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11640 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11641 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11642 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011643
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645 Example :
11646 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11647 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11648 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11649 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11652 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11653 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11654 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011655
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011658---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011660Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11661every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011662order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11665---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011666FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011667HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011668HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11669HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011670HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11671HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11672HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11673HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11674LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011675METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11676METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11677METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11678METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11679METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11680METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011681RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011683TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011684WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11685---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011686
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116888. Logging
11689----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011691One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11692provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11693very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11694provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11695state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011696to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697headers.
11698
11699In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11700about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11701send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11702
11703 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11704 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11705 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11706 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11707 at the termination.
11708
11709The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11710allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11711as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11712while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11713real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11714delay.
11715
11716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117178.1. Log levels
11718---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011719
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011720TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011721source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011722HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11723in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11724track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11725syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11726about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727
11728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117298.2. Log formats
11730----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011731
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011732HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011733and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11734slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11735options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011736
11737 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11738 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11739 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11740 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11741 extents.
11742
11743 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11744 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11745 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11746 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11747 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11748
11749 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11750 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11751 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11752 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11753 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11754
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011755 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11756 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11757 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11758 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11759
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011760 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11761
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011762Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11763specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11764field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11765servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11766always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11767identifier.
11768
11769Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11770 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11771 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11772 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11773 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11774
11775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117768.2.1. Default log format
11777-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011778
11779This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11780as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11781format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11782
11783 Example :
11784 listen www
11785 mode http
11786 log global
11787 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11788
11789 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11790 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11791 (www/HTTP)
11792
11793 Field Format Extract from the example above
11794 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11795 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11796 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11797 4 'to' to
11798 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11799 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11800
11801Detailed fields description :
11802 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11803 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11804 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11805 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11806 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11807 and processed the connection.
11808 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11809
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011810In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11811"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11812connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11813
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011814It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11815will eventually disappear.
11816
11817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118188.2.2. TCP log format
11819---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820
11821The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11822is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11823information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11824counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11825emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11826environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11827the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11828sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011829specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11830not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11831fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11832marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011833
11834 Example :
11835 frontend fnt
11836 mode tcp
11837 option tcplog
11838 log global
11839 default_backend bck
11840
11841 backend bck
11842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11843
11844 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11845 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11846 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11847
11848 Field Format Extract from the example above
11849 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11850 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11851 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11852 4 frontend_name fnt
11853 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11854 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11855 7 bytes_read* 212
11856 8 termination_state --
11857 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11858 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11859
11860Detailed fields description :
11861 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011862 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11863 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11864 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11865 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11866 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011867
11868 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011869 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11870 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11871 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872
11873 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11874 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11875 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11876 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11877
11878 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11879 and processed the connection.
11880
11881 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11882 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11883 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11884 applications.
11885
11886 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11887 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11888 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11889 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11890 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11891
11892 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11893 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11894 See "Timers" below for more details.
11895
11896 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11897 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11898 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11899 "Timers" below for more details.
11900
11901 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011902 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011903 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11904 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11905 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11906 details.
11907
11908 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11909 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11910 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11911 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11912 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11913
11914 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11915 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11916 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11917 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11918 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11919 for more details.
11920
11921 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011922 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011923 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11924 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11925 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011926 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011927
11928 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11929 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11930 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11931 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11932 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11933 caused by a denial of service attack.
11934
11935 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11936 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11937 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11938 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11939 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11940 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11941 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11942 denial of service attack.
11943
11944 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11945 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11946 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11947 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11948 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11949 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11950 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11951 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11952 be processed than on other servers.
11953
11954 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11955 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11956 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11957 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11958 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11959 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11960 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11961 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11962 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11963 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11964 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11965 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11966 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11967
11968 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11969 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11970 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11971 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11972 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11973 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11974 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11975 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11976
11977 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11978 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11979 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11980 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11981 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11982 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11983 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11984 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11985 occurs.
11986
11987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119888.2.3. HTTP log format
11989----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011990
11991The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11992is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11993the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11994are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11995emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11996generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11997"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11998which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011999frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12000is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012001
12002Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12003slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12004with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12005
12006 Example :
12007 frontend http-in
12008 mode http
12009 option httplog
12010 log global
12011 default_backend bck
12012
12013 backend static
12014 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12015
12016 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12017 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12018 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012019 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012020
12021 Field Format Extract from the example above
12022 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12023 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12024 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12025 4 frontend_name http-in
12026 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12027 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12028 7 status_code 200
12029 8 bytes_read* 2750
12030 9 captured_request_cookie -
12031 10 captured_response_cookie -
12032 11 termination_state ----
12033 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12034 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12035 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12036 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12037 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012039
12040Detailed fields description :
12041 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012042 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12043 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12044 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12045 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12046 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012047
12048 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012049 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12050 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12051 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012052
12053 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12054 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12055 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12056 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12057 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12058
12059 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12060 and processed the connection.
12061
12062 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12063 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12064 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12065
12066 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12067 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12068 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12069 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12070 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12071 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12072
12073 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12074 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12075 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12076 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12077 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12078 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12079
12080 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12081 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12082 See "Timers" below for more details.
12083
12084 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12085 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12086 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12087 below for more details.
12088
12089 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12090 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12091 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12092 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12093 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12094 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12095 for more details.
12096
12097 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012098 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012099 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12100 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12101 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12102 details.
12103
12104 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12105 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12106 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12107
12108 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12109 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12110 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12111 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12112 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12113 overflowing.
12114
12115 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12116 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12117 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12118 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12119 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12120 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12121 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12122 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12123
12124 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12125 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12126 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12127 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12128 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12129 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12130 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12131 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12132
12133 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12134 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12135 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12136 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12137 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12138 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12139 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12140
12141 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012142 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12144 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12145 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147 system.
12148
12149 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12150 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12151 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12152 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12153 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12154 caused by a denial of service attack.
12155
12156 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12157 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12158 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12159 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12160 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12161 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12162 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12163 denial of service attack.
12164
12165 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12166 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12167 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12168 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12169 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12170 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12171 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12172 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12173 processed than on other servers.
12174
12175 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12176 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12177 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12178 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12179 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12180 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12181 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12182 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12183 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12184 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12185 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12186 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12187 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12188
12189 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12190 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12191 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12192 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12193 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12194 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12195 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12196 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12197
12198 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12199 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12200 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12201 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12202 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12203 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12204 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12205 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12206 occurs.
12207
12208 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12209 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12210 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12211 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12212 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12213 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12214 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12215 cookies" below for more details.
12216
12217 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12218 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12219 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12220 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12221 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12222 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12223 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12224 and cookies" below for more details.
12225
12226 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12227 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12228 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12229 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12230 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12231 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12232 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12233 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12234
12235
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122368.2.4. Custom log format
12237------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012238
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012239The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012240mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012241
12242HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12243Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12244separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12245prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12246
12247Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12248variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12249string formats ("Q").
12250
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012251If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012252as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012253less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12254the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12255
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012256Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012257In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012258in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012259
12260Flags are :
12261 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012262 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012263
12264 Example:
12265
12266 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12267 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12268
12269At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12270
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012271 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12272 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012273
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012274the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012275
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012276 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012277 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012278 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012280and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12281
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012282 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012283 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12284
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012285Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12286
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012287 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012288 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012289 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12290 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12291 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012292 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12293 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12294 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012295 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012296 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012297 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012298 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012299 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012300 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012301 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12302 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012303 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012304 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12305 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012306 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012307 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12308 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012309 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12310 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12311 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012312 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012313 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12314 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012315 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012316 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12317 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12318 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012319 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012320 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12321 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12322 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12323 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012324 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012325 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012326 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012327 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012328 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012329 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012330 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12331 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12332 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012333 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012334 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12335 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012336 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012337 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012338 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012340
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012341 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012342
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012343
123448.2.5. Error log format
12345-----------------------
12346
12347When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12348protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12349By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12350"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12351will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12352logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12353
12354The format looks like this :
12355
12356 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12357 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12358 Connection error during SSL handshake
12359
12360 Field Format Extract from the example above
12361 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12362 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12363 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12364 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12365 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12366
12367These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12368failures.
12369
12370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123718.3. Advanced logging options
12372-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012373
12374Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12375just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12376options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12377for more information about their usage.
12378
12379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12381------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012382
12383It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12384haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12385commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12386monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12387ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12388
12389 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12390 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12391 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12392 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12393
12394 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12395 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12396 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012397 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012398 such as other load-balancers.
12399
12400 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12401 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12402 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12403
12404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12406----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012407
12408The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12409what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12410or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12411"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12412just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12413log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12414after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12415is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12416with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12417with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12418
12419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124208.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12421------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012422
12423Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12424for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12425"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12426retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12427raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12428a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12429file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12430you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12431"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12432
12433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124348.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12435--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012436
12437Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12438multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12439them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12440"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12441logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12442error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12443and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12444too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12445useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12446alternative.
12447
12448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124498.4. Timing events
12450------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012451
12452Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12453reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12454the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12455frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12456mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12457
12458 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12459 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12460 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12461 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12462 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12463
12464 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12465 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12466 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12467 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12468 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12469
12470 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12471 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12472 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12473 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12474 connection never established.
12475
12476 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12477 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12478 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12479 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12480 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12481 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12482 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12483 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12484 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12485 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12486 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12487
12488 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12489 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12490 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12491 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012492 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012493
12494 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12495
12496 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12497 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12498 negative.
12499
12500These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12501protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12502that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012503due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012504close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12505session has been aborted on timeout.
12506
12507Most common cases :
12508
12509 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12510 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12511 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12512 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12513 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12514 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12515 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12516 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12517 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012518 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12519 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12520 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012521
12522 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12523 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12524 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12525 of ms on remote networks.
12526
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012527 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12528 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12529 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012530
12531 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12532 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12533 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12534 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12535 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12536 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12537 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12538 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12539 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12540 to the server until another one is released.
12541
12542Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12543
12544 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12545 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12546 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12547
12548 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12549 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12550 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12551
12552 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12553 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12554 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12555 flags.
12556
12557 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12558 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12559 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12560 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12561 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12562 the client connection was maintained open.
12563
12564 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012565 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012566 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12567 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12568
12569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125708.5. Session state at disconnection
12571-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012572
12573TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12574"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12576each of which has a special meaning :
12577
12578 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12579 session to terminate :
12580
12581 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12582
12583 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12584 server explicitly refused it.
12585
12586 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12587 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12588 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12589 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012590 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12591
12592 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12593 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012594
12595 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12596 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12597 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12598 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12599 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12600
12601 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12602 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12603 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12604 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12605 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12606
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012607 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12608 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12609
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012610 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12611 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12612 backup connections when going up.
12613
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012614 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012616 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12617 send or receive data.
12618
12619 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12620 send or receive data.
12621
12622 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12623 with nothing left in the buffers.
12624
12625 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12626
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012627 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012628 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12629
12630 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12631 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12632 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12633 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12634 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12635
12636 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12637 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12638
12639 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12640 server (HTTP only).
12641
12642 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12643
12644 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12645 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12646 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12647
12648 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12649 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12650 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12651
12652 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12653
12654 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12655 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12656
12657 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12658 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12659 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12660
12661 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12662 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012663 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12664 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012665
12666 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12667 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12668 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12669 another server.
12670
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012671 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012672 server.
12673
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012674 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12675 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12676 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12677 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12678
12679 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12680 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12681 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12682 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12683
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012684 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12685 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12686 "use-server" rule).
12687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12689
12690 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12691 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12692
12693 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12694
12695 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12696 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12697 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12698
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012699 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12700 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012701 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012702 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12703 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012705 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12706
12707 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12708 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12709
12710 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12711
12712 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12713
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012714The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12715was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012716helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12717starvation, attacks, etc...
12718
12719The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12720alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12721easier finding and understanding.
12722
12723 Flags Reason
12724
12725 -- Normal termination.
12726
12727 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12728 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12729 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12730 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12731
12732 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12733 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12734 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12735 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12736 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12737 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012739 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12740 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012741 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012742
12743 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12744 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12745 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12746
12747 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12748 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12749 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12750 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12751 the server takes too long to respond.
12752
12753 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12754 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12755 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12756 long a time to respond.
12757
12758 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12759 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12760 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12761 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12762 and the client.
12763
12764 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12765 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12766 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12767 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12768 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012769 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12770 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12771 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12772 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12773 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12774 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12775 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12776 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12777 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12778 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12779 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12780 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12781 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12782 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012783
12784 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12785 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012786 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12787 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12788 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12789 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012790
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012791 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12792 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012794 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012795 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12796 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12797 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12798 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12799 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12800
12801 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12802 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12803 503 or 504 here.
12804
12805 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12806 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12807 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12808 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12809 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12810
12811 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12812 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012813 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012814 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12815 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12816
12817 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12818 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12819 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12820 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12821 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12822 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12823 between haproxy and the server.
12824
12825 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12826 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12827 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12828 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12829 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12830 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12831 solution is to fix the application.
12832
12833 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12834 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12835 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12836 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12837 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12838 external attacks.
12839
12840 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12841 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012842 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012843 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12844 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12845
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012846 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12847 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12848 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012849 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12850 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012851
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012852 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12853 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12854 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12855 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012856 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12857 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12858 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12859 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12860 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012861
12862 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12863 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12864 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12865 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12866
12867 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12868 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12869 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12870 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12871
12872 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12873 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12874 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12875 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12876
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012877The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12878persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12879important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12880re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12881
12882 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12883
12884 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12885 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12886 set on a GET request.
12887
12888 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12889 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012890 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012891 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12892
12893 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12894 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12895 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12896
12897 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12898 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12899 already got a cookie.
12900
12901 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12902 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12903 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12904 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12905 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12906
12907 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12908 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12909 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12910
12911 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12912 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12913 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12914
12915 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12916 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12917
12918 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12919 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12920 then advertised in the response.
12921
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129238.6. Non-printable characters
12924-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012925
12926In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12927consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12928converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12929prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12930being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12931escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12932is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12933'}' when logging headers.
12934
12935Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12936issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12937containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12938
12939Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12940the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12941performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12942
12943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12945---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012946
12947Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12948achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012949section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012950cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12951the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12952the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012954not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12955user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12956a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12957wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12958
12959 Examples :
12960 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12961 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12962
12963 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12964 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12965
12966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12968---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012969
12970Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12971proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12972the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12973server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12974
12975Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12976response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012977section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012978
12979It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012980time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12981appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012982are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12983and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12984follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12985request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12986in the logs.
12987
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012988As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12989frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12990an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992 Example :
12993 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12994 listen proxy-out
12995 mode http
12996 option httplog
12997 option logasap
12998 log global
12999 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13000
13001 # log the name of the virtual server
13002 capture request header Host len 20
13003
13004 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13005 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13006
13007 # log the beginning of the referrer
13008 capture request header Referer len 20
13009
13010 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13011 capture response header Server len 20
13012
13013 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13014 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13015
13016 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13017 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13018
13019 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13020 capture response header Via len 20
13021
13022 # log the URL location during a redirection
13023 capture response header Location len 20
13024
13025 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13026 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13027 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13028 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13029 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13030
13031 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13032 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13033 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13034 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013035 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013036
13037 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13038 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13039 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13040 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13041 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013042 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013043
13044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130458.9. Examples of logs
13046---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013047
13048These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13049them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13050reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13051
13052 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13053 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13054 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13055
13056 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13057 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13058
13059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13060 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13061 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13062
13063 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13064 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13065
13066 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13067 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13068 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13069
13070 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013071 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013072 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13073 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13074
13075 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13076 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13077 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13078
13079 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13080 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013081 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013082 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13083 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13084 to return the 502 and not the server.
13085
13086 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013087 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013088
13089 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13090 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13091 Nothing was sent to any server.
13092
13093 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13094 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13095
13096 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13097 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13098 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13099 send a 408 return code to the client.
13100
13101 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13102 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13103
13104 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13105 5 seconds ("c----").
13106
13107 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13108 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013109 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013110
13111 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013112 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13114 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13115 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13116 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13117 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013118
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131209. Statistics and monitoring
13121----------------------------
13122
13123It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13124mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13125CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13126Unix socket.
13127
13128
131299.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013130---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013131
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013132The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013133page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13134begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13135represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13136use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13137('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13138(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13139text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13140do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13141use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013142
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013143In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13144that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13145S (Servers).
13146
13147 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13148 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13149 any name for server/listener)
13150 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13151 number queued without a server assigned.
13152 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13153 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13154 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13155 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13156 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13157 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13158 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13159 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13160 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13161 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13162 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13163 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13164 "option checkcache".
13165 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13166 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13167 - read error from the client
13168 - client timeout
13169 - client closed connection
13170 - various bad requests from the client.
13171 - request was tarpitted.
13172 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13173 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13174 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13175 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13176 active servers).
13177 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13178 Some other errors are:
13179 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13180 - failure applying filters to the response.
13181 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13182 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13183 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13184 switched away from.
13185 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13186 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13187 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13188 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13189 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13190 the server is up.)
13191 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13192 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13193 counters for each server.
13194 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13195 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13196 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13197 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13198 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13199 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13200 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13201 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13202 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13203 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13204 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13205 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13206 of times that server was selected.
13207 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13208 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13209 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13210 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13211 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13212 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013213 UNK -> unknown
13214 INI -> initializing
13215 SOCKERR -> socket error
13216 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13217 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13218 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13219 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13220 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13221 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13222 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13223 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13224 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13225 disable-on-404
13226 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13227 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13228 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013229 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13230 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13231 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13232 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13233 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13234 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13235 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13236 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13237 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13238 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13239 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13240 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13241 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13242 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13243 (inc. in eresp)
13244 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13245 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13246 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13247 (CPU/BW limit)
13248 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13249 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13250 server/backend
13251 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13252 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13253 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13254 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13255 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13256 (0 for TCP)
13257 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13258 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013259
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132619.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013262-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013263
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013264The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13265necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13266A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13267issuing commands by hand :
13268
13269 global
13270 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13271 stats timeout 2m
13272
13273It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13274the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13275never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13276situations :
13277
13278 global
13279 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13280 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13281 stats timeout 2m
13282
13283To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13284swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13285to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13286syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13287
13288 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13289 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13290
13291The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13292script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13293for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13294
13295The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13296that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13297editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13298(eg: watch a counter).
13299
13300The socket supports two operation modes :
13301 - interactive
13302 - non-interactive
13303
13304The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13305this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13306sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13307mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13308commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13309example :
13310
13311 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13312
13313The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13314entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13315for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13316sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13317"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13318after processing the last command of the same line.
13319
13320For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13321"prompt" command :
13322
13323 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13324 prompt
13325 > show info
13326 ...
13327 >
13328
13329Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13330delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13331that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13332parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013333
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013334It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13335on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13336own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013337
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013338The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13339If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13340all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13341it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13342
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013343add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013344 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13345 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13346 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13347 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013348
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013349add map <map> <key> <value>
13350 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13351 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013352 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13353 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13354 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013355
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013356clear counters
13357 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13358 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13359 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13360 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13361 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13362
13363clear counters all
13364 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13365 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13366 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13367
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013368clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013369 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13370 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13371 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013372
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013373clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013374 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13375 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13376 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013377
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013378clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13379 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13380
13381 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13382 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13383 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13384 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13385 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13386 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13387
13388 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13389
13390 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13391 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13392 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13393 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13394 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13395 the ACLs :
13396
13397 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13398 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13399 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13400 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13401 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13402 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13403
13404 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013405 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13406 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013407
13408 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013409 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013410 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013411 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13412 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13413 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13414 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013415
13416 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13417
13418 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013419 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013420 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13421 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013422 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13423 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13424 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013425
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013426del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13427 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013428 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13429 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13430 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13431 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013432
13433del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013434 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013435 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13436 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13437 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13438 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013439
13440disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013441 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13442
13443 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13444 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13445 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13446 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13447 re-enabled using enable agent.
13448
13449 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13450 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13451 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13452 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13453 otherwise unchanged.
13454
13455 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13456 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13457 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13458
13459 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13460 level "admin".
13461
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013462disable frontend <frontend>
13463 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13464 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13465 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13466 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13467 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13468 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13469 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13470 on the stats page.
13471
13472 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13473 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13474
13475 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13476 level "admin".
13477
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013478disable health <backend>/<server>
13479 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13480 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13481 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13482 agent check forces it down.
13483
13484 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13485 level "admin".
13486
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013487disable server <backend>/<server>
13488 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13489 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13490 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13491 during the maintenance.
13492
13493 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13494 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13495
13496 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013497 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013498
13499 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13500 level "admin".
13501
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013502enable agent <backend>/<server>
13503 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13504
13505 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13506 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13507
13508 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13509 level "admin".
13510
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013511enable frontend <frontend>
13512 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13513 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13514 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13515 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13516 which was disabled.
13517
13518 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13519 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13520
13521 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13522 level "admin".
13523
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013524enable health <backend>/<server>
13525 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13526 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13527
13528 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13529 level "admin".
13530
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013531enable server <backend>/<server>
13532 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13533 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13534
13535 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013536 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013537
13538 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13539 level "admin".
13540
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013541get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013542get acl <acl> <value>
13543 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13544 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13545 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13546 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13547 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013548
13549 The first two words are:
13550
13551 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13552 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13553 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13554
13555 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13556
13557 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13558
13559 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13560
13561 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13562 interpretation of the case.
13563
13564 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13565 useful with regular expressions.
13566
13567 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13568 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13569
13570 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13571 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13572 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13573
13574 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13575
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013576get weight <backend>/<server>
13577 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13578 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13579 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13580 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13581 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013582 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013583
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013584help
13585 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13586 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013587
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013588prompt
13589 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13590 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13591 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13592 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13593 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13594 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13595 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13596 command.
13597
13598quit
13599 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013600
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013601set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013602 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13603 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13604 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013605
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013606set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013607 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13608 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13609 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13610 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13611 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013612 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13613 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13614
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013615set maxconn global <maxconn>
13616 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13617 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13618 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13619 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13620 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13621 setting.
13622
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013623set rate-limit connections global <value>
13624 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13625 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13626 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13627 is passed in number of connections per second.
13628
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013629set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13630 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13631 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013632 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13633 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013634
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013635set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13636 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13637 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13638 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13639 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13640
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013641set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13642 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13643 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13644 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13645 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13646 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13647
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013648set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13649 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13650 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13651 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13652
13653set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13654 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13655 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13656 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13657
13658set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13659 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13660 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13661 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13662 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13663 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13664 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13665 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13666 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13667
13668set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13669 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13670 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13671
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013672set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13673 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13674 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13675 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13676 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13677
13678 Example:
13679 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13680 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13681 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13682 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13683
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013684set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013685 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13686 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13687 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13688 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013689 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13690 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013691
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013692set timeout cli <delay>
13693 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13694 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13695 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13696
13697set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13698 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13699 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013700 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13701 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13702 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13703 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13704 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13705 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13706 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13707 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13708 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13709 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13710 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13711 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13712 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013713
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013714show errors [<iid>]
13715 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13716 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013717 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13718 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13719 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013720
13721 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13722 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13723 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13724 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13725 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13726 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13727 are reported too.
13728
13729 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13730 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13731 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13732 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13733 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13734 code.
13735
13736 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13737 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13738 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13739 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13740 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13741 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13742 line.
13743
13744 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013745 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13746 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013747 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13748 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13749
13750 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13751 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13752 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13753 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13754 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13755 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13756 00204+ minal\r\n
13757 00211 \r\n
13758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013759 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013760 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13761 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13762 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13763 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13764 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13765 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013766
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013767show info
13768 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13769
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013770show map [<map>]
13771 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013772 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13773 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13774 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13775 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13776 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13777 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013778
13779show acl [<acl>]
13780 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013781 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13782 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13783 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13784 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13785 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013786
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013787show pools
13788 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13789 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13790 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13791 the pools.
13792
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013793show sess
13794 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013795 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13796 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13797
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013798show sess <id>
13799 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13800 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13801 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13802 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13803 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013804 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13805 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13806
13807 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13808 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013809
13810show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13811 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13812 possible to dump only selected items :
13813 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13814 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13815 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13816 for example:
13817 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13818 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13819 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13820
13821 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013822 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13823 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013824 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13825 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13826 Nbproc: 1
13827 Process_num: 1
13828 (...)
13829
13830 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13831 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13832 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13833 (...)
13834 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13835
13836 $
13837
13838 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13839 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13840 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13841 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013842 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013843
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013844show table
13845 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13846 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13847 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13848 entries currently in use.
13849
13850 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013851 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013852 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13853 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013854
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013855show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013856 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13857 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13858 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013859 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13860
13861 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13862 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13863 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13864 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13865 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13866
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013867 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13868 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13869 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13870 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13871 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13872 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13873
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013874
13875 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013876 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13877 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013878
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013879 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013880 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013881 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013882 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13883 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13884 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13885 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013886
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013887 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013888 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013889 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13890 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013891
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013892 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13893 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013894 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013895 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13896 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013897
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013898 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13899 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013900 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013901 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13902 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13903
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013904 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13905 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13906 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13907 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13908 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13909
13910 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13911 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13912 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013913 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13914 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013915 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13916 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013917
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013918shutdown frontend <frontend>
13919 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13920 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13921 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13922 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13923 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13924 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13925 once it is terminated.
13926
13927 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13928 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13929
13930 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13931 level "admin".
13932
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013933shutdown session <id>
13934 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13935 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13936 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13937 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13938 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13939 flag in the logs.
13940
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013941shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013942 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13943 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13944 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13945 'K' flag in the logs.
13946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013947/*
13948 * Local variables:
13949 * fill-column: 79
13950 * End:
13951 */